Final Report EIA Drilling

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 286
At a glance
Powered by AI
The document discusses Statoil's environmental impact assessment for offshore drilling operations and assesses chemicals used for ecological hazards.

The document provides an environmental impact assessment for Statoil's offshore drilling operations.

Drilling activities include positioning the drill ship, drilling, usage of mud and cement, cuttings and mud disposal, well testing, well abandonment, and logistics support.

Final Report

EIA Drilling
Prepared for:

Wisma Pondok Indah II, Suite 602


Jl. Sultan Iskandar Muda, Kav. V-TA
Jakarta 12310, Indonesia

October 2010

Delivering sustainable solutions in a more competitive world

TABLE OF CONTENTS
TABLE OF CONTENTS ..........................................................................................i
LIST OF TABLES.....................................................................................................v
LIST OF FIGURES ..............................................................................................viii
LIST OF APPENDICES .........................................................................................ix
1

INTRODUCTION......................................................................................1-1

1.1

GENERAL INTRODUCTION TO THE PROJECT ...............................................1-1

1.2

GENERAL INFORMATION ABOUT STATOIL ..................................................1-3

1.3

POLICY, LEGISLATIVE AND ADMINISTRATIVE FRAMEWORK......................1-3

1.4

IMPACT ASSESSMENT APPROACH METHODOLOGY ....................................1-6


1.4.1

Scoping ........................................................................................1-10

1.4.2

Describing the Baseline .............................................................1-10

1.4.3

Impact Prediction.......................................................................1-10

1.4.4

Evaluating the Significance of a Predicted Impact................1-11

1.4.5

Mitigation & Benefit Enhancement .........................................1-12

1.4.6

Residual Impacts ........................................................................1-13

1.4.7

Management & Monitoring......................................................1-13

PROJECT DESCRIPTION........................................................................2-1

2.1

INTRODUCTION .............................................................................................2-1

2.2

PROJECT OVERVIEW AND LOCATION ..........................................................2-2

2.3

PRINCIPLE PROJECT ACTIVITIES ...................................................................2-2

2.4

2.3.1

Positioning of the Drill Ship .......................................................2-2

2.3.2

Drilling Activities.........................................................................2-2

2.3.3

Drilling Mud & Cement Usage ..................................................2-6

2.3.4

Cuttings & Mud Disposal ...........................................................2-7

2.3.5

Well Testing and Clean Up.........................................................2-7

2.3.6

Well Abandonment......................................................................2-7

2.3.7

Supply, Support Logistics...........................................................2-8

DRILL SHIP SPECIFICATIONS.........................................................................2-8


2.4.1

Storage facilities ...........................................................................2-9

2.4.2

Electrical Power Generation .......................................................2-9

2.4.3

Cooling Water and Drilling Water Supply...............................2-9

2.4.4

Sewage Treatment........................................................................2-9

2.4.5

Drainage System ........................................................................2-10

2.5

DRILLING SCHEDULE ..................................................................................2-10

2.6

EMISSIONS, DISCHARGES, WASTE & NOISE EMISSIONS............................2-10


2.6.1

Air Emissions..............................................................................2-10

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2.6.2

Discharges to Sea .......................................................................2-11

2.6.3

Hazardous and Non-hazardous Waste Generation..............2-13

2.6.4

Noise ............................................................................................2-13

CHARACTERIZATION OF THE INFLUENCED AREA ...................3-1

3.1

PETROSEA OFFSHORE SUPPLY BASE (POSB) ...............................................3-1

3.2

3.1.1

Climate ..........................................................................................3-1

3.1.2

Socio Economy and Cultural......................................................3-3

PROJECT LOCATION FOR DRILLING ACTIVITY-KARAMA BLOCK ...............3-5


3.2.1

Defining the Project Zone of Influence .....................................3-5

3.2.2

Meteorology..................................................................................3-7

3.2.3

Tectonics and Geology ................................................................3-7

3.2.4

Oceanography ..............................................................................3-7

3.2.5

Water and Sediment Quality....................................................3-16

3.2.6

Marine Flora and Fauna............................................................3-21

3.2.7

Fish ...............................................................................................3-22

3.2.8

Marine Mammals .......................................................................3-22

3.2.9

Turtles..........................................................................................3-24

3.2.10

Sea Birds in Open seas and Coastal areas...............................3-26

3.2.11

Coastal habitats ..........................................................................3-28

3.2.12

Mangrove Forest ........................................................................3-28

3.2.13

Coastal Forest .............................................................................3-29

3.2.14

Social Characterization..............................................................3-33

3.2.15

Custom and Religion .................................................................3-37

3.2.16

Education and Literacy .............................................................3-38

3.2.17

Public and Private Infrastructure ............................................3-40

3.2.18

Socio-Economics and Livelihood.............................................3-44

3.2.19

Health ..........................................................................................3-57

3.2.20

Stakeholder Identification and Engagement..........................3-60

3.2.21

Statoil CSR Program ..................................................................3-64

3.2.22

Identification and Characterization of Indigenous


Groups .........................................................................................3-67

IMPACT EVALUATION AND CONTROL .........................................4-1

4.1

SCOPING.........................................................................................................4-1

4.2

AIR QUALITY .................................................................................................4-4

4.3

4.2.1

Sources of Impact .........................................................................4-4

4.2.2

Assessment Approach.................................................................4-4

4.2.3

Evaluation of Impacts..................................................................4-5

4.2.4

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts ................................4-6

NOISE LEVELS ................................................................................................4-6


4.3.1

Sources of Impact .........................................................................4-6

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

ii

4.4

4.5

4.6

4.7

4.8

4.9

4.3.2

Assessment Approach.................................................................4-6

4.3.3

Evaluation of Impacts..................................................................4-7

4.3.4

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts ................................4-9

WASTE GENERATION AND DISPOSAL ..........................................................4-9


4.4.1

Sources of Impact .........................................................................4-9

4.4.2

Assessment Approach.................................................................4-9

4.4.3

Evaluation of Impacts................................................................4-11

4.4.4

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts ..............................4-12

WATER QUALITY .........................................................................................4-12


4.5.1

Sources of Impact .......................................................................4-12

4.5.2

Assessment Approach...............................................................4-13

4.5.3

Evaluation of Impacts................................................................4-13

4.5.4

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts ..............................4-14

SEABED & BENTHIC COMMUNITIES ...........................................................4-15


4.6.1

Sources of Impact .......................................................................4-15

4.6.2

Assessment Approach...............................................................4-15

4.6.3

Evaluation of Impacts................................................................4-16

4.6.4

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts ..............................4-16

FISHERIES .....................................................................................................4-17
4.7.1

Sources of Impact .......................................................................4-17

4.7.2

Assessment Approach...............................................................4-17

4.7.3

Evaluation of Impacts................................................................4-17

4.7.4

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts ..............................4-18

UNPLANNED EVENTS .................................................................................4-19


4.8.1

Sources of Impact .......................................................................4-19

4.8.2

Assessment Approach...............................................................4-19

4.8.3

Evaluation of Impacts................................................................4-20

4.8.4

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts ..............................4-22

SOCIO-ECONOMIC BENEFITS ......................................................................4-23


4.9.1

Sources of Impacts .....................................................................4-23

4.9.2

Assessment Approach...............................................................4-23

4.9.3

Evaluation of Impacts................................................................4-23

4.9.4

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impact ................................4-24

ENVIRONMENTAL MANAGEMENT PLAN .....................................5-1

5.1

INTRODUCTION .............................................................................................5-1

5.2

STATOILS HSE PRINCIPLES ..........................................................................5-1

5.3

ENVIRONMENTAL MANAGEMENT PLAN ....................................................5-2

5.4

ROLES AND RESPONSIBILITIES ......................................................................5-7


5.4.1

Role of Statoil Project Team........................................................5-7

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

iii

5.4.2

Role of Drilling Contractor .........................................................5-8

5.5

COMPETENCIES AND TRAINING ...................................................................5-8

5.6

INSPECTION, AUDIT AND CORRECTIVE ACTIONS .......................................5-9


5.6.1

Daily Inspections..........................................................................5-9

5.6.2

Fortnightly Audits .......................................................................5-9

5.6.3

Ad-hoc Audits ............................................................................5-10

5.6.4

Audit Reporting .........................................................................5-10

5.7

REPORTING AND STAKEHOLDER COMMUNICATION ................................5-10

5.8

ENVIRONMENTAL MONITORING ...............................................................5-10

5.9

5.8.1

Seabed Sediments/ Benthic Community ...............................5-11

5.8.2

Drilling Waste.............................................................................5-11

5.8.3

Waste Management ...................................................................5-12

5.8.4

Accidental Events/ Upset Conditions ....................................5-12

OIL SPILL CONTINGENCY/ RESPONSE PLAN ............................................5-12

5.10 REVIEW AND REVISION ...............................................................................5-13


6

CONCLUSIONS ..............................................................................................6-1

6.1

INTRODUCTION .............................................................................................6-1

6.2

ENVIRONMENTAL CONCERNS ......................................................................6-1

6.3

OUTCOME OF THE IMPACT ASSESSMENT......................................................6-1

6.4

SUMMARY CONCLUSION ...............................................................................6-2

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

iv

LIST OF TABLES
Table 1-1

List of Regulation and Governing Documents concerning


Offshore Operations of Statoil......................................................... 1-3

Table 1-2

Definitions Used in this IA .............................................................. 1-9

Table 2-1

Typical Mud Types and Quantities for each Hole Section.......... 2-6

Table 2-2

Likely Mud Types to be Used for the Karama Drilling


Program .............................................................................................. 2-6

Table 2-3

Vessel & Manning Requirements during Drilling........................ 2-8

Table 2-4

Bulk Storage Facilities....................................................................... 2-9

Table 2-5

Proposed Drilling Schedule ........................................................... 2-10

Table 2-6

Drilling Air Emissions .................................................................... 2-11

Table 2-7

Estimated Volumes of Cuttings Discharged ............................... 2-12

Table 2-8

Estimated Volumes of Operational Discharges to Sea............... 2-12

Table 2-9

Typical Development Drilling Wastes ......................................... 2-13

Table 2-10 Sound Sources from Various Maritime Activities...................... 2-14


Table 3-1

Variation of mean monthly surface current vector within


Karama Block from January to December ................................... 3-12

Table 3-2

Some migratory birds in western Sulawesi (Holmes and


Phillips, 1999)................................................................................... 3-26

Table 3-3

Sea Birds in Western Sulawesi (Holmes and Phillips, 1999)..... 3-27

Table 3-4

Birds Found in Mangrove Forrest of Western Sulawesi............ 3-28

Table 3-5

Population Development and Growth of Mamuju Regency,


2000-2007 .......................................................................................... 3-34

Table 3-6

Population Distribution and Density of Mamuju Regency


2004 and 2007................................................................................... 3-34

Table 3-7

Gender Ratio of Mamuju Regency, 2006 and 2007..................... 3-35

Table 3-8

Population Composition Based on Age and Gender in


Mamuju Regency, 2004 and 2006.................................................. 3-36

Table 3-9

Population Structure Based on Religion in Mamuju Regency . 3-38

Table 3-10 Number of Schools. Teachers and Students in Mamuju in


2007.................................................................................................... 3-38
Table 3-11 Universities and Academies in West Sulawesi Province .......... 3-39
Table 3-12 Transportation Facilities in West Sulawesi Province ................. 3-40
Table 3-13 Road Length by Government Responsibility per Type of
Surface in Mamuju Regency, 2007 (in Km) ................................. 3-41
Table 3-14 Road Condition by Government Responsibility per
Conditions in Mamuju Regency. 2007 (in Km) ........................... 3-41

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

Table 3-15 Number of Telephone Lines Based on Customers Categories


in Mamuju Regency ........................................................................ 3-43
Table 3-16 Number of Facilities of Trading and Services in Mamuju
Regency ............................................................................................ 3-43
Table 3-17 Population Structure Based on Employment in Mamuju
Regency ............................................................................................ 3-44
Table 3-18 Minimum Wages in West Sulawesi Province, 2005 - 2009 ........ 3-45
Table 3-19 Land Used of Mamuju Regency, 2006......................................... 3-45
Table 3-20 Spatial Distribution of Forest Function in Mamuju Regency,
2006.................................................................................................... 3-46
Table 3-21 Local and Scientific Names and Value of Mainly Fish
Caught in 2006 ................................................................................. 3-46
Table 3-22 Number of Production in West Sulawesi .................................... 3-47
Table 3-23 Commodity of high economic value in 2006 and 2007 .............. 3-48
Table 3-24 Numbers of fishing vessel by regencies in 2006 and 2007
(unit).................................................................................................. 3-48
Table 3-25 Numbers and type of fishing gears in West Sulawesi (unit) .... 3-49
Table 3-26 Category and Numbers of FAD in Karama Block, 2008............ 3-51
Table 3-27 Summary of Fishing Activities in Mamuju District ................... 3-52
Table 3-28 Potential areas of seaweed, production and numbers of
households ....................................................................................... 3-55
Table 3-29 Number of Patient and Death by Kind of Disease In
Mamuju Regency, 2005-2007 ......................................................... 3-58
Table 3-30 Number of live births per District in Mamuju Regency,
2005-2007 .......................................................................................... 3-58
Table 3-31 Number of Health Facilities per District in Mamuju
Regency, 2007................................................................................... 3-59
Table 3-32 Number of Paramedic by Kinds of Paramedic per SubDistrict in Mamuju Regency, 2007 ................................................ 3-59
Table 3-33 Stakeholder Identification and Areas of Interest........................ 3-62
Table 4-1

Evaluation of Impact Significance .................................................. 4-2

Table 4-2

Air Emission Standards.................................................................... 4-4

Table 4-3

Magnitude Criteria for Assessing Air Emissions ......................... 4-5

Table 4-4

Receptor/ Resource Sensitivity for Assessment of Air


Emissions............................................................................................ 4-5

Table 4-5

Magnitude Criteria for Impacts on Noise Levels ......................... 4-7

Table 4-6

Receptor/Resource Sensitivity for Assessment of Noise


Levels .................................................................................................. 4-7

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

vi

Table 4-7

Requirements for the Management and Disposal of Drill


Muds and Cuttings ......................................................................... 4-10

Table 4-8

Magnitude Criteria for Waste Generation and Disposal........... 4-11

Table 4-9

Receptor/ Resource Sensitivity for Waste Generation


and Disposal .................................................................................... 4-11

Table 4-10 Magnitude Criteria for Water Quality Impacts .......................... 4-13
Table 4-11 Receptor/ Resource Sensitivity for Water Quality
Impacts ............................................................................................. 4-13
Table 4-12 Magnitude Criteria for Sediment Quality and Impacts
on Benthic Community .................................................................. 4-15
Table 4-13 Receptor/Resource Sensitivity for Sediment Quality and
Impacts on Benthic Community ................................................... 4-15
Table 4-14 Magnitude Criteria for Impacts on Fisheries .............................. 4-17
Table 4-15 Receptor/ Resource Sensitivity for Impacts on Fisheries.......... 4-17
Table 4-16 Magnitude Criteria for for Impacts resulting from
Unplanned Events........................................................................... 4-19
Table 4-17 Receptor/ Resource Sensitivity for Impacts resulting
from Unplanned Events ................................................................. 4-20
Table 4-18 Summary of Model Results ........................................................... 4-21
Table 4-19 Magnitude Criteria for Assessment of Socio-Economic
Impacts ............................................................................................. 4-23
Table 5-1

Environmental Management Plan .................................................. 5-3

Table 5-2

Monitoring of Sediments/ Benthic Community ........................ 5-11

Table 5-3

Monitoring of Drilling Mud & Chemical Use: Drilling


OCN Reports.................................................................................... 5-12

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

vii

LIST OF FIGURES
Figure 1-1

Project Location-Karama Block .................................................. 1-2

Figure 1-2

Overview of IA Approach .......................................................... 1-8

Figure 1-3

Evaluation of Impact Significance ........................................... 1-12

Figure 2-1

GSF Explorer Drill Ship............................................................... 2-1

Figure 2-2

Proposed Location of the Three Exploration Wells................. 2-4

Figure 2-3

Proposed Well Design ................................................................. 2-5

Figure 3-1

Project Zone of Influence) ............................................................3-6

Figure 3-2

Windrose in the study area (left March 2008 and right


October 2008 windrose)................................................................3-8

Figure 3-3

Bathymetry of Karama Block.......................................................3-9

Figure 3-4

Vertical profile at Makassar Strait (a) Temperature (b)


Salinity ..........................................................................................3-10

Figure 3-5

Stick plot of the current vector at several depths at MAK


I (west mooring) measured during Arlindo experiment
at Labani Channel from July 2005 June 2006........................3-12

Figure 3-6

Time series of wave characteristics: (i) significant wave


height (upper), (ii) mean wave period (middle), and (iii)
mean wave direction (lower) along a north-south
section acquired from European Climate Moderate
Range Weather Forecast (ECMWF) ..........................................3-14

Figure 3-7

Comparison between tide measurement (blue) and


results of tide prediction (red) at Mamuju from 1 22
April 2009. ....................................................................................3-15

Figure 3-8

Water column and sediment quality sampling locations......3-19

Figure 3-9

Eel Spawning Area......................................................................3-23

Figure 3-10

Sea Turtle Map.............................................................................3-25

Figure 3-11

Typical Narrow Band of Mangrove Ecosystem Found in


Mamuju due to Steep Topography at Coast of Mamuju .......3-29

Figure 3-12

Pescaprae Formation around Coast of Mamuju .....................3-30

Figure 3-13

Baringtonia Formation of Mamuju ...........................................3-30

Figure 3-14

Location of Mampie Lampoko Reservation ............................3-32

Figure 3-15

Karampuang Island (A) and Main Activities: (B)


Inhabitant/Village, (C) Recreational Resort run by local
government, and (D) Floating net aquaculture ......................3-33

Figure 3-16

Participation of the education level ..........................................3-39

Figure 3-17

Transportation lines ....................................................................3-42

Figure 3-18

Working Population based on Education Level in


Mamuju Regency in 2007 ...........................................................3-44

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

viii

Figure 3-19

Potential fishing areas.................................................................3-50

Figure 3-20

Rumpon location .........................................................................3-54

Figure 3-21

Seaweed cultivation area............................................................3-56

Figure 4-1

Scoping Matrix...............................................................................4-3

LIST OF APPENDICES
Appendix 1:

Oil Spill and Drilling Cuttings Modelling Result

Appendix 2:

Analytical Result of Seawater Quality

Appendix 3:

Analytical Result of Seabed Sediment Quality

Appendix 4:

Stakeholder Engagement Meeting

Appendix 5:

Master Impact Tables

Appendix 6:

Drilling Chemical Characteristics

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

ix

Final Report
EIA Drilling

PT. ERM Indonesia


Wisma Aldiron Dirgantara
nd
2 floor, Suite 238-239
Jl. Gatot Subroto Kav. 72
Jakarta 12870
Indonesia
Telephone +62 21 7918 1904
Facsimile +62 21 7918 1905
Website: www.erm.com

Client.

Project No.
0103283

Summary.

Date.

22 October 2010
Approved by

Included in this report.

Paul Douglass
President Director
ERM Indonesia

Revision

By

Description

This report has been prepared by Environmental Resources


Management with all reasonable skill, care and diligence within the
terms of the Contract with the client, incorporating our General
Terms and Conditions of Business and taking account of the
resources devoted to it by agreement with the client.
We disclaim any responsibility to the client and others in respect or
any matters outside the scope of the above.
This report is confidential to the client and we accept no
responsibility of whatsoever nature to any third parties to whom this
report, or any part thereof, is made known. Any such party relies
upon the report at their own risk.

Checked

Distribution
Internal
Public
Confidential

Approved

Date

INTRODUCTION

1.1

GENERAL INTRODUCTION TO THE PROJECT


Statoil Indonesia Karama As (Statoil) and partner Pertamina plan to
undertake an exploration drilling program of three deep-water exploration
wells at Karama Block in the Makassar Strait, offshore West Sulawesi
Province in 2011. The purpose of this project is to discover the oil or gas
targets identified from interpretation of 3D seismic survey data.
The Karama Block is located in the Makassar Strait. The nearest land is
around 12 km (7.5 miles) West of Mamuju Regency, West Sulawesi province.
According to the Government Regulation No. 32 of 2004 regarding Regional
Government, some of the activity locations in Karama Block are,
administratively, under the authority of the West Sulawesi Province
Government (4-12 miles) and most of the locations are under the Central
Government authority (>12 miles).
The exploration block is consist of an area of approximately 4,287 km2 from
north to south (Figure 1-1) in water depths ranging from 1,660-1,825 m.
Drilling operations are currently planned to begin in early January and
February 2011 for the first and second wells and in July 2011 for the third
well.
An Environmental Impact Assessment (EIA or AMDAL) is not required
under Indonesian Regulation for exploration drilling activities. This IA is
being completed in line with Statoils corporate requirements and covers only
the exploration drilling activities for the Karama Block. Currently, the exact
locations of the three exploration wells have not yet been determined; final
locations of the wells will be determined based on the interpretation of data
gathered during the 3D seismic survey of the area (which is currently in
progress).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

1-1

Figure 1-1

Project Location-Karama Block

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

1-2

1.2

GENERAL INFORMATION ABOUT STATOIL


Statoil is an international energy company with over 35 years experience on
the Norwegian continental shelf, today with operations in 40 countries. The
company is headquartered in Norway with 29,000 employees worldwide, and
are listed on the New York and Oslo stock exchanges.
Statoil is a global leader in subsea developments, and is widely recognized as
a pioneer in deepwater drilling, increased oil recovery (IOR), and carbon
capture and storage (CCS).
Statoil Indonesia Karama AS is a wholly owned subsidiary of Statoil ASA,
which established an Indonesian office in August 2007. Currently the Statoil
Indonesia office is located in Wisma Pondok Indah II, Suite 602, Jl. Sultan
Iskandar Muda, Kav. V-TA, Jakarta 12310, Indonesia.
Statoil has a Production Sharing Contract (PSC) with BPMIGAS that allows
Statoil to conduct exploration activities of the Karama block. The contract
agreement is for 30 years (2007-2037). The three commitment wells in the
Karama PSC will be drilled in 2011.

1.3

POLICY, LEGISLATIVE AND ADMINISTRATIVE FRAMEWORK


Environmental regulations concerning Statoils offshore operations that have
to be placed as top priorities to comply with among others are listed in the
table below.
Table 1-1

List of Regulation and Governing Documents concerning Offshore


Operations of Statoil
Regulation

Description

National Regulations
Act No. 1 of 1973 on Indonesian Continental
Shelf

Regulation on border and sea territory based


on continental shelf and pollution control

Act No. 5 of 1983 on Indonesian Exclusive


Economic Zone

Adopts the rule in UNCLOS 1982 of


determining the borderlines as areas further
then 200 miles

Act No. 6 of 1996 on Indonesian Water

Activities of usage, management, protection


and preservation of the Indonesian water
environment

Act No. 5 of 1990 regarding Natural


Resource Conservation and Ecosystem

The project proponent needs to refer to this


regulation when dealing with natural resource
conservation and ecosystems within the
project area.

Act No. 6 of 1994 regarding Ratification on


the UN Convention on Climate Change

Project activities may potentially generate


greenhouse gasses, hence shall refer to this
Convention.

Act No. 27 of 2007 concerning Coastal Zone


and Small Islands Management

The management of coastal zone and small


islands refers to this Act

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

1-3

Regulation

Description

Act No 32 of 2004 concerning Regional


Government

Authority, responsibility and obligation of the


Regional Government is regulated in this Act

Act No. 17 of 2004 concerning the


Enactment of the Kyoto Protocol to the
United Nations Framework Convention on
Climate Change

Project activities may potentially


generate greenhouse gasses,
hence
shall refer to this Protocol

Act No. 32 of 2009 concerning


Environmental Protection and Management

Environmental matters related to the project


activities shall comply with this Act.
Company shall follow guidance stipulated in
this act on conducting environmental
protection and management activity.

Act No. 45 of 2009 jo 31 of 2004 concerning


Fisheries

Fisheries management including optimizing


the management of fish resources, the
preservation of fish resources, fish cultivation
and spatial planning refer to this Act.

Government Regulation No. 27 of 1999


concerning Environmental Impact
Assessment (AMDAL)

Requirement of activities/businesses that have


significant impacts to the environment to
conduct an AMDAL study

Government Regulation No. 7 of 1999


concerning Flora and Fauna Conservation

Conservation of protected flora and fauna


within project area shall refer to this
Regulation.

Government Regulation No. 18 of 1999; and


No. 85of 1999 concerning Hazardous and
Toxic Waste Management

Guidance of identification and management of


hazardous and toxic waste (B3). Hazardous
and toxic waste generated from the activity
shall refer to this Regulation.

Government Regulation No. 41 of 1999


concerning Air Pollution Control

Project potentially emits gaseous pollutant


that may influence the ambient air quality
hence control of air pollution shall refer to this
Regulation

Government Regulation No. 25 of 2000


concerning Government Authority and the
Authority of Province as a Region with
Autonomy

Administration of the project to government


should consider authority portions of local/
regional and central government as stipulated
by this Regulation.

Government Regulation No. 74 of 2001


concerning Hazardous and Toxic Material
Management

Project activities will use chemicals therefore


management of the chemicals (transportation,
handling, and storage) shall comply to this
Regulation.

Presidential Regulation No. 109 of 2006


concerning Emergencies Response for Oil
Spillage in the Sea

Emergency response and handling of oil spill


at sea should follow this Regulation

Presidential Decree Number 32 Year 1990


regarding Management of Protection Areas

This decree lists type of protection areas


(sensitive areas) and their management.
Liquid and solid wastes disposal are not
allowed in the protection areas

Ministry of Environment Decree No. KEP48/MENLH/11/1996 concerning Noise


Standard.

Noise should be managed and monitored in


order to meet prevailing environmental noise
standards

Ministry of Environment Decree No. 200 of


2004 concerning Standard Criteria for
Environmental Damage and Guidelines for
the Determination of Status of Sea Grass
Colonies

Determination of environmental damage and


status of sea grass colonies shall refer to this
Regulation.

Ministry of Environment Decree No. 201 of


2004 concerning Standard Criteria for

Determination of environmental and


mangrove ecosystem damage shall refer to

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

1-4

Regulation

Description

Environmental Damage and Guidelines for


the Determining the Extent of Damage to
Mangroves

this Regulation.

Ministry of Environment Decree No. 51 of


2004 concerning Sea Water Quality
Standard

Sea water quality in the project area shall refer


to this Regulation.

Ministry of Environment Regulation No. 8


of 2006 concerning Guidelines to Prepare
Environmental Impact Assessment.

This Regulation provides guidelines for


compilation of the KA, ANDAL, RKL, RPL
and Executive Summary documents.

Ministry of Environment Regulation No. 11


of 2006 concerning Sort of Business and/or
Activities Plan that Require to Conduct
Environmental Impact Assessment.

Mandatory to conduct an AMDAL study for a


prescribed list of activities and /or business

Ministry of Environment Regulation No. 12


of 2006 concerning Terms and Permitting
Procedures for Effluent Disposal to the
Marine Environment.

Effluent water discharge to marine


environment shall refer to this Regulation.

Ministry of Environment Regulation No. 04


of 2007 concerning Effluent Water Standard
for Offshore Oil and Gas Exploration and
Production

Water effluent discharged from the activity


should comply with this Regulation.

Ministry of Mining and Energy Decree No.


KEP-103.K/008/M.PE/1989 concerning
Supervision on Environmental Management
and Monitoring Plan in the Field of Mining
and Energy.

Environmental Management and Monitoring


Plan implementation will be inspected by an
assigned Mine Inspector

Ministry of Mining and Energy Decree No.


1457K/28/MEM/2000 concerning Technical
Guidelines of Environmental Management
in Mine and Energy Sector.

EIA preparation in mining and energy sector


shall refer to this Decree

Ministry of Energy and Mineral Resources


Regulation No. 045 Year 2006 concerning
Management of Drilling Mud, Drilling Mud
Waste, and Cuttings in the Oil and Gas
Drilling Activity

Management of Drilling Mud Waste and


Cuttings in the Oil and Gas Drilling Activity
shall follow this regulation

Head of Impact Control Agency Decree No.


056/BAPEDAL/03/1994 concerning
Guidelines to Determine Scale of
Significance Environmental Impacts.

The scale of impacts should be clearly stated


in the environmental impact assessment
documents referring to this Decree.

Head of Impact Control Agency Decree No.


KEP-01/BAPEDAL/09/1995 concerning
Procedures and Requirements for Storage
and Collection of Hazardous and Toxic
Waste.

Hazardous waste generated by the project


should be stored and collected in accordance
with this Decree.

Head of Impact Control Agency Decree No.


8 of 2000 concerning Community
Involvement and Information Disclosure in
the Process of Environmental Impact
Assessment

Community involvement and information


disclosure in relation to the AMDAL process
shall refer to this regulation.

International Regulations
World Bank Group Emission Level TR1011

Offshore Plants

World Bank Group liquid effluent levels


which should be achieved from offshore oil
and gas production.

World Bank Group Emission Level TR1011

World Bank Group air emission levels which

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

1-5

Regulation

Description

Offshore Plants

should be achieved from offshore oil and gas


production.

UNCLOS and Law No. 17 of 1982 on


Maritime Law

Sea water areas based on the functions and


authority.

International Convention of the Safety of


Life at Sea (SOLAS) of 1974 Chapter IX
concerning Management for the Safe
Operation of Ships

The Chapter makes mandatory the


International Safety Management (ISM) Code,
which requires a safety management system to
be established by the shipowner or any person
who has assumed responsibility for the ship
(the "Company").

International Convention for the Prevention


of Pollution from Ships of 1973, as modified
by the Protocol of 1978 (MARPOL)

The Convention includes regulations aimed at


preventing and minimizing pollution from
ships - both accidental pollution and that from
routine operations

Statoil Governing Documents


TR 0926-Working Environment

Describes Statoil working environment


standards and design guidelines which
applies for project development as well as all
operational activities including plants,
facilities and buildings onshore and offshore
managed by Statoil

TR1011-Technical Environment

Describes Statoil technical environmental


requirement for all offshore activities.

standard for design, modification and


operation of offshore plants
FR10-HSE Risk management

1.4

Describes Statoil requirement for HSE Risk


Management (RM) and the applicable
associated functions, activities and processes

IMPACT ASSESSMENT APPROACH METHODOLOGY


The IA process is a part of the Statoil overall Management System. Findings,
results and commitments from the IA process are followed up by Statoil
through specific project governance documents. The purpose of the IA
process is to help the project manage its risks and improve its social and
environmental performance throughout the project life. The process should
be integrated; addressing all relevant HSE/CSR risks, impacts and benefits of
the project; and potential impacts to the project.
It is considered essential by Statoil that the IA process starts early, thus
making it possible to take advantage of findings and results in the technical
engineering process and further project planning.
All projects by Statoil (seismic surveys, exploration, field development, major
modifications, abandonment of existing facilities, and other relevant projects
like wind farms, bio fuel production, refinery plants, infrastructure projects,
etc) shall undertake impact assessments according to the Statoils guideline
document. The following are the key elements of the IA process :

Project definition;

Screening and categorisation of the project;

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

1-6

Scoping of the IA process;

Stakeholder identification and analysis;

Gathering and analysis of relevant baseline data;

Stakeholder engagement;

Risk and impact identification and analysis;

Identification and assessment of mitigation and enhancement measures


and actions;

Follow up: Implementation of measures, monitoring and reporting.

Typical time-line for IA processes for exploration and oil and gas field
development by Statoil is as follow:
Wind Parks
Exploration
Field development

DG2

DG1
DG0

DGC
DG1

AP1 DG2

RTDE
DG3

DG3
DG0
DG4

Project definition

Impact assessment phases

Screening and categorisation


Scoping
Stakeholder idenitfication and analysis
Gathering and analysis of baseline
data
Stakeholder engagement
Risk and impact identification and
analysis
Identification and assessment of
mitigation and enhancement measures
Follow up

Following project screening process (project categorization) in accordance


with Indonesia Ministry of Environment Regulation Number 11 Year 2006,
oil and gas exploration drilling activity is considered as project that does not
require a full AMDAL (EIA) study but UKL-UKL (Environmental
Management Effort and Environmental Monitoring Effort) document is
obliged to be prepared by Statoil.
Statoil has conducted stakeholder identification and analysis which is
described in detail in Chapter 3. This then was followed by Public
Consultation/Socialization attended by key stakeholders in the project area
and related institutions in West Sulawesi Province. Public consultation was
particularly intended:

To gather suggestions, opinions, and responses concerning the oil and gas
exploration activity as part of scoping process

To protect public interest surrounding the activity area from potential


impact that may arise from the project.

To establish an atmosphere of equal partnerhip between the parties


interest in oil and gas exploration activity in Karama Block.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

1-7

To respect the right of all parties to obtain information relating to oil and
gas exploration activities in the Karama Block.

During Public Consultation/Socialization, the participants were actively


involved in providing critical inputs associated with oil and gas exploration
drilling plan in Karama Block. Summary of key issues raised by the
participants are as follow :

Water quality aspect related to drilling cutting and drilling mud


management.

Social and Economics aspect related to job opportunity for local people,
community development program and compensation to rumpon owner
and fishing group affected by the activity.

More comprehensive socialization activities involving communities


proximity to the project location.

Those steps then followed by IA of the planned oil and gas exploration
drilling activity in Karama Block. In this report, the impact assessment has
been undertaken following a systematic process that predicts and evaluates
the impacts the proposed exploration drilling program is expected to have on
aspects of the physical, biological, and socio-economic environment, and
identifies measures that Statoil will take to avoid, reduce, remedy, offset or
compensate for adverse impacts, and to provide benefits, as far as is
practicable.
The overall approach followed is shown schematically in Figure 1-2 while the
key steps taken are described in subsequent sections. Definitions used
throughout this impact assessment are described in Table 1-2.

Baseline studies (existing data


collection and new surveys)

Assessment
Predict magnitude of impacts

Evaluate their significance

Investigate options for mitigation

Reassess residual impact (as required)

Stakeholder engagement

Interaction with project planning and design

Scoping

Management Plans

Reporting and Disclosure

Figure 1-2

Overview of IA Approach

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

1-8

Table 1-2

Definitions Used in this IA

Term

Definition

Project

The Project is defined as including all those actions and activities which are a
necessary part of the Exploration Drilling campaign, including those aspects
without which the Project cannot proceed. This includes presence of chase
boats; the drilling, disposal/ discharges of wastes, etc.

Area of
Influence

Impacts have been assessed throughout the Area of Influence of the Project.
This varies depending on the type of impact being considered but includes all
that area within which it is considered significant impacts could occur, taking
into account: (a) the physical footprint of the proposed Project and (b) the
nature of the baseline environment and manner in which impacts are likely to
be propagated beyond the Project boundary.
For this Project, most impacts are expected to be mainly localized and are not
expected to extend across national boundaries. However, in the case of the
generation of greenhouse gases, the area of influence extends globally.

Type of
Impact

The assessment has considered both positive and negative impacts of the
Project. Positive or beneficial impacts are those that are considered to present
an improvement to the baseline or to introduce a new, desirable factor.
Negative or adverse impacts are the reverse.

Resources &
Receptors

The term resources is used to describe features of the environment such as


water resources, clean air and habitats etc, which are valued by society for
their intrinsic worth and/or their social or economic contribution. The term
receptors is used to define people and communities who may be affected by
the Project.

Environment

Aspects of the environment in the context of this Project include:


The physical environment, including climate, air, underwater noise;
The biological or natural environment, including marine habitats, biodiversity
at the community, species and genetic levels; protected areas and ecosystem
values;
The social and socio-economic environment including people and their
livelihood, their health, welfare, amenity, safety and security; employment
and incomes; local, regional and national economies.

Timeframe of
Impact

Impacts include: permanent impacts that will arise from irreversible changes
in conditions such as the removal of a natural feature; temporary impacts, ie.
those that arise from short term activities such as unplanned events; and
longer term impacts that will arise over the duration of Project activities.
Short and long term impacts will cease on completion of the relevant activities
although there may be a period before the environment returns to its previous
condition. Given the nature of Exploration Drilling, no longer term impacts
are expected to occur.
Within each of the above categories, the assessment considers impacts which
are one-off or recurrent, and continuous or intermittent. If intermittent, the
impacts occur at varying frequency, and at regular, or irregular intervals (eg.
depending on operating or weather conditions).

Nature of
Impact

The assessment includes direct impacts arising from activities associated with
the Project (primary impacts) and impacts that follow on as a consequence of
these (secondary impacts). So, for example, the release of drill cuttings/
muds into the sea will have a direct affect on water quality. A change in
water quality can then lead to a secondary effect on marine organisms.
The Project can also have an induced impact by stimulating other
developments to take place which are not directly within the scope of or
essential to the development of the Project. Whilst these associated
developments are not part of the Project, their induced impacts are caused at
least in part by the Project and they are therefore considered in the
assessment.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

1-9

Term

1.4.1

Definition

Cumulative
Impacts

The Project may also be taking place at the same time as other developments
causing impacts affecting the same resources or receptors, such that there will
be cumulative effects with the proposed Project.

Routine and
Non-Routine
Impacts

Finally, this IA has assessed both routine impacts resulting from planned
activities of the Project; and non-routine impacts that could arise from
unplanned or accidental events within the Project such as accidental spills of
drilling fluids or a well blow out. The impact of non-routine events is
assessed in terms of Risk, ie. taking into account both the consequence of the
event and the probability of occurrence (Risk = probability x consequence).

Scoping
The first stage of the assessment involved identifying the likely significant
impacts of the Project that require further investigation. This aims to focus
the assessment on the likely significant impacts. This involved the systematic
consideration of the potential for interaction between activities involved in
the Project and aspects of the physical, biological, socio-economic
environment that may be affected. The results of scoping are presented in
Section 4.

1.4.2

Describing the Baseline


To provide a baseline against which the impacts of the Project can be
assessed, a description of physical, biological and socio-economic conditions
that will prevail in the absence of the Project has been prepared as presented
in Section 3. Due to the screening classification, baseline data for this
assessment have been derived from secondary, publically available data
sources and monitoring data gathered in the Block between September and
October 2009.

1.4.3

Impact Prediction
The assessment describes what could happen to the existing baseline as a
result of the project by predicting the magnitude of impacts. The term
magnitude is used as shorthand to encompass all the dimensions of the
predicted impact including:

The nature of the change (what is affected and how);

Its size, scale or intensity;

Its geographical extent and distribution;

Its duration, frequency, reversibility, etc; and

Where relevant, the probability of the impact occurring as a result of


accidental or unplanned events.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

1-10

It also includes any uncertainty about the occurrence of scale of the impact,
expressed as ranges, confidence limits or likelihood (1). Impacts have then
been graded as being of small, medium or large magnitude according to
criteria developed for each aspect and presented in Section 4.
1.4.4

Evaluating the Significance of a Predicted Impact


Though there is statutory definition of significance of impacts in accordance
with Head of Impact Control Agency Decree No. 056/BAPEDAL/03/1994
regarding Guidelines to Determine Scale of Significance Environmental
Impacts.; however, it is relevant for use in AMDAL compilation following
Ministry of Environment Regulation No. 08 of 2006 regarding AMDAL
Compilation Guidelines. Therefore the following practical definition of
significant of impact is used in this impact assessment:
An impact is significant if, in isolation or in combination with other impacts,
it should, in the judgment of the EIA team, be reported in the EIA report so
that it can be taken into account in decision making on whether the Project
should proceed and if so under what conditions.
This recognizes that evaluation requires an exercise of judgment and that
judgments may vary between parties in the process. The evaluation of
impacts that is presented in this Report is based on the judgment of the
impact assessment team, informed by reference to Indonesias legal standards
and government policy, international good practice and the views of
stakeholders.
Where standards are not available or provide insufficient information on their
own to allow grading of significance, significance has been evaluated taking
into account the magnitude of the impact and the value or sensitivity of the
affected resource or receptor. The value of a resource is judged taking into
account its quality and its importance as represented, for example, by its
local, regional, national or international designation, its importance to the
local or wider community, or its economic value. The sensitivity of receptors,
for example a household, community or wider social group, will take into
account their likely response to the change and their ability to adapt to and
manage the effects of the impact. Where receptor sensitivity has been
considered in impact evaluation, criteria used to establish sensitivity have
been included in Section 4.

(1) A distinction is made here between the probability of impact arising from a non-routine event such as an
accidental spill or fire, and the likelihood of an uncertain impact; for example it may not be certain that health
will be affected by air emissions or that jobs will be obtained by local people.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

1-11

Magnitude and value/sensitivity are looked at in combination to evaluate


whether an impact is significant and if so its degree of significance. The
principle is illustrated in Figure 1-3.

Magnitude of Impact
Evaluation of Significance
Low

Low
Value/ Sensitivity
of resources/
receptor

Medium

High

Figure 1-3

1.4.5

Medium

High

Not
significant

Minor

Moderate

Minor

Moderate

ModerateMajor

Moderate

ModerateMajor

Major

Evaluation of Impact Significance

Mitigation & Benefit Enhancement


Where significant impacts could occur or opportunities to enhance benefits
identified, practical ways of mitigating those impacts or enhancing benefits as
far as possible have been included.
Where a significant negative impact is identified, a hierarchy of options for
mitigation has been considered to identify the preferred approach:

Avoid at source remove the source of the impact;

Abate at source reduce the source of the impact;

Attenuate reduce the impact between the source and the receptor;

Abate at the receptor reduce the impact at the receptor;

Remedy repair the damage after it has occurred; and

Compensate / Offset replace in kind or with a different resource of


equal value.

Mitigation and benefit enhancement recommendations are described in


Section 4 of this report.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

1-12

1.4.6

Residual Impacts
In some cases, it may only be possible to reduce the impact to a certain
degree. These impacts are therefore residual in the sense that they remain
after mitigation measures have been designed into the intended activity. The
degree of significance attributed to residual impacts is related to the weight
the impact assessment team considers should be given to them in reaching a
decision on the Project:

1.4.7

Any residual impacts of major significance, whether positive or negative,


are considered to warrant substantial weight in decision making on
whether (and if so how) the Project should proceed, when compared with
other environmental, social or economic costs and benefits. If the Project
is approved to proceed, conditions should be imposed to ensure adverse
impacts are strictly controlled and monitored and beneficial impacts are
fully delivered;

Residual impacts of moderate significance are considered to be of


reducing importance to decision-making on how the Project should
proceed, but still warrant careful attention to conditions regarding
mitigation and monitoring, to ensure best available techniques are used to
keep adverse impacts to as low as reasonably practicable (ALARP) for the
Project, and to ensure beneficial impacts are delivered;

Residual impacts of minor significance should be brought to the attention


of the decision-maker but are identified as warranting little if any weight
in the decision of whether and how the Project should proceed.
Mitigation can be achieved using normal good practice and monitoring
should be carried out to confirm that impacts do not exceed predicted
levels;

Not significant residual impacts are those that, after assessment, are found
not to be significant to the decision making about the Project; and

Where the residual impact is of more than minor significance, this


assessment explains how the impact has been reduced to as low as
reasonably practicable (ALARP) for the Project.

Management & Monitoring


A wide range of different measures to mitigate and manage impacts have
been identified through this assessment. Furthermore, where uncertainty
exists about the significance of an impact, monitoring has been
recommended. These mitigation, management and monitoring measures are
set out in Sections 5.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

1-13

PROJECT DESCRIPTION

2.1

INTRODUCTION
This section provides a description of the proposed exploration drilling
program operations in the Karama licence area including the following:

Project overview and location;

Descriptions of the principal activities and well design;

Details of the drilling rig;

A summary of the principal emissions, effluents and wastes generated


during key activities; and

An implementation schedule for the drilling program.

This assessment has been prepared on the basis that drilling will be conducted
using the drill ship GSF Explorer operated by Transocean. A photograph of
the GSF Explorer is shown in Figure 2-1.

Figure 2-1

GSF Explorer Drill Ship

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-1

2.2

PROJECT OVERVIEW AND LOCATION


Statoil are planning to drill three exploration wells (Anoman, Laksmana and
Gatot-kaca) within the Karama Block in the Makassar Strait, offshore West
Sulawesi (see Figure 2-2). The wells will be drilled in water depths ranging
between 1,6601,825 m. The nearest distance to shoreline of the outermost
island or to mainland for for each of the wells is Anoman well 34 km (to
mainland), Laksmana well 19 km (to Karampuan Island) and Gatot-kaca 35
km (to mainland).
The supply base for the exploration drilling activities will be the Petrosea
Offshore Supply Base (POSB) at Balikpapan, which is located approximately
185 km (120 miles see Figure 1-1) from the Karama Block. POSB is well
equipped with a deepwater quay for large platform supply vessels (PSVs).

2.3

PRINCIPLE PROJECT ACTIVITIES

2.3.1

Positioning of the Drill Ship


The GSF Explorer is a dynamically positioned (DP) drill ship designed to
operate at water depths of up to 2,300 m. Several thrusters are mounted
around the base of the drill ship which will be used to maintain the position
of the ship precisely on the well location. These thrusters will be controlled
by a computer that determines the exact position of the ship from special
sensors attached to the well and on the drill ship itself. The drill ship will be
supported by two large PSVs, one high speed support vessel and one
helicopter.

2.3.2

Drilling Activities

2.3.2.1

Drilling Process
Once in position at the designated well-site, drilling will commence. Wells
are drilled by using a bit that chips off pieces of rock, called cuttings. The
drill bit is connected to the surface by segments of hollow pipe, which
together are called the drill string. Drilling mud is pumped down through
the centre of the drill string and returned to the surface through the space
between the drill string and the rock formations or casing, known as the
annulus. Often the top section of the well (or top-hole) is drilled without a
riser in place and the drill cuttings and environmental-friendly water-based
mud are discharged directly on the seabed in proximity of the well.
The function of drilling mud includes cooling and lubricating the drill bit,
removing and transporting cuttings to the surface, counterbalancing
formation pressure to prevent formation fluids (ie. liquid hydrocarbons, gas
and water) from entering the well prematurely and preventing the open
(uncased) wellbore from caving in. As the well is drilled, metal casing is

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-2

placed inside the well to line it and stabilize the hole to prevent it caving in.
The casing also isolates aquifers and hydrocarbon bearing zones through
which the well passes, thus preventing liquids or gases entering the well
prematurely. After each casing string has been installed, it is cemented in
place. The casing also provides a firm point for the attachment of the
blowout preventor (BOP) stack.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-3

Figure 2-2

Proposed Location of the Three Exploration Wells

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-4

2.3.2.2

Karama Drilling Plan


The well drilling will involve 3 (three) wells with the average well depth of
5,425 m. Water based muds (WBMs) will be used to drill the initial phase (ie.
as indicated in Figure 2-3) while the remainder of the well will be drilled
using synthetic based muds (SBMs). The first step in the drilling sequence
will be to drill a 36 top hole section into the seabed into which the conductor
pipe is cemented.
A 30 diameter hole will then be drilled to a depth of ~ 2,300 as an optional
plan. If the 36 conductor casing cannot be set as planned depth, a 26 casing
will then be set A 26 diameter hole will be drilled to a total depth of 2,612 m
and a 20 casing run into the hole and set in place. The BOP stack and riser
will then be installed. This is followed by drilling a 20, 17-1/2 hole and a
14-1/2 hole. A 12-1/4 hole will then be drilled to a depth of about 4,593 m;
the 9-5/8 liner will be run into the hole and set in place. Finally an 8-1/2
hole will then be drilled to the planned total depth (TD) of approximately
5,425 m.
A schematic representation of the casing design for the well is shown in
Figure 2-3.
Hole Size

Casing Size @ TVD

Mud Type

36

36 Conductor Casing @ 1,970 m

WBM

30

26 Surface Casing @ 2,300 m

WBM

26

20 Surface Casing @ 2,612 m

WBM

20

16 Protective Liner @ 3,374 m

SBM

17 1/2

13 5/8 Intermediate Casing @ 3,648 m

SBM

14 1/2

11 3/4 Protective Liner @ 3,983 m

SBM

12 1/4

9 5/8 Drilling Liner @ 4,593 m

SBM

2400

3550
3600

8 1/2

Open Hole @ 5,425 m

SBM

Source: Drilling Well Design, September 2009

Figure 2-3

Proposed Well Design

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-5

2.3.3

Drilling Mud & Cement Usage


Both water-based muds (WBM) and synthetic based muds (SBM) will be used
for the Karama drilling program. A simple water based mud (spud mud)
will be used for the upper hole sections; a synthetic based mud will be used
for lower hole sections. Typical mud types for each hole section including
quantities for the drilling program are indicated in Table 2-1 and Table 2-2.
Table 2-1

Typical Mud Types and Quantities for each Hole Section

Components
Open Hole
Diameter
Casing/Liner
Diameter
Fluid Type
Mud Density (sg)
Mud
Usage/Discharge
(m3)

Table 2-2

36

30

26

Well Sections
20
17.5

14.5

12

8.5

36

26

20

16

13 5/8

11

9 5/8

WBM
1.03
328

WBM
1.03
332

WBM
1.18
3502

SBM
1.18
213

SBM
1.20
303

SBM
1.20
230

SBM
1.20
161

SBM
88

Likely Mud Types to be Used for the Karama Drilling Program

Mud Components
WBMs
Bentonite Bulk
Barite Bulk
Drill Water
BARAZAN D
Calcium Chloride Brine
(11,6)
Caustic Soda
Guar Gum/ Xanthan gum
PAC-LE
Soda ash
Sodium Bicarbonates
SBMs
EDC 95/11
EZ MUL NT
Calcium Chloride powder
Lime hydrated
RHEMOD L
LIQUITONE
Calcium Carbonate Fine

Function

Quantity

OCNS
Ratings*

Weight additive
Weight additive
Additive
Viscosifier
Weighting/ bridging agent

2205 lbs/BB
2205 lbs/BB
862 m3
55 lbs/sx
740 lbs

E
E
E
E

pH Controller
Stabilizer/ emulsifier
Fluid loss additive
pH controller
pH controller

55 lbs/sx
55 lbs/sx
55 lbs/sx
6818 bbl
25 kg/sx

E
E
E

Base oil
Emulsifier/ wetting agent
Weighting/ bridging agent
Alkalinity agent
Rheology/ suspension
HTHP filtration agent
Additive

593 m3
441 lbs/drum
55 lbs/sx
55 lbs/sx
441 lbs/drum
450 lbs/drum
55 lbs/sx

D
E
E
Gold
E

Note:
* Under OSPARs Offshore Chemical Notification System (OCNS), chemicals used in the offshore oil
and gas industry are assessed in terms of their ecological hazard. Two approaches are used
depending on the use of the chemical; either a Hazard Quotient (HQ) is given; expressed as a Colour
Band (Gold having lowest hazard and purple having the highest hazard; or an OCNS Group,
expressed as a letter from A to E (A having the highest risk hazard and E having the lowest)
The majority of chemicals being used are classified as posing little or no risk to the environment. The
environmental characteristics of drilling fluid chemicals, including contingency chemicals, to be
used are presented in Appendix 6.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-6

During SBM drilling, the drilling mud is circulated in a closed loop system
which recycles the drilling fluid and removes the drilling wastes (cuttings).
During drilling, the returns from downhole (mud and cuttings) are routed to
the solids control system (shaleshakers, sand trap, hydrocyclones, centrifuge
etc.) which physically separate the drill cuttings and sand from the drilling
mud. SBM drill mud is collected for re-conditioning and reuse whilst the
separated cuttings are discharged overboard.
Cement is usually prepared on board the drill rig in marginally greater
quantity than is expected to be required. Any left-over cement is typically
discharged overboard. It is estimated that approximately 421 m3 of cement
will be used for each well. During the casing of the 26 hole section, surplus
cement (~ 15 m3) will be released directly into the sea at seabed level from the
top of the well. There will be no planned discharge from the other sections of
the well.
2.3.4

Cuttings & Mud Disposal


Top-hole drilling will be conducted using seawater and HiVis Sweeps
(WBM). During drilling of the 36 and 30 top-hole section, drill cuttings and
WBM will be discharged directly onto the seabed. Once the section is
complete and the 36 conductor and 26 casing set, mud and cuttings will be
periodically disposed into the sea through a discharge chute located ~ 12 m
below the water surface.
SBMs will be used to drill the remainder of the well. During SBM drilling, a
closed system will be used whereby the mud and cuttings are separated on
board the drill ship, by routing returns from downhole (mud and cuttings) to
the solid control system which physically separate the drill cuttings and sand
from the drilling mud. Once separated, the cuttings will be dried (to about 30
-50 g/kg oil content or 3 - 5%) in a separate cuttings dryer system and
disposed of overboard through the discharge chute. The muds will be reused
and once drilling is complete the muds will be returned to the POSB at
Balikpapan for storage.
Estimated quantities of drill cuttings and muds generated during exploration
drilling are provided in Section 2.6.

2.3.5

Well Testing and Clean Up


No testing of the wells is currently planned.

2.3.6

Well Abandonment
The wells will be permanently plugged with cement after drilling according
to Statoil requirements and Indonesian legislations. This includes the
following:

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-7

Cement plugs with a minimum length of 100 m will be set to isolate


hydrocarbon bearing and / or permeable zones in open hole;

Cement plugs will extend a minimum of 50 m from the top of the


permeable zone and upwards, or 50 m from the potential flow point and
upwards; and

The cementing of perforated intervals will be evaluated where there exists


the possibility of undesirable cross flow from the perforations or poor
annular cementation directly above the perforations.

The wellheads will however remain in place; ie 2 m above seabed or to leave


the wellheads on the seafloor, the wellheads, casing, piling and other
obstructions will be removed to a depth of 4.6 m below the seafloor and all
obstructions removed.
2.3.7

Supply, Support Logistics


Personnel will be transferred to the drill ship by Helicopter (which can take
10 passengers at a time) from the POSB at Balikpapan. Approximately 2
flights a day are expected (during the day only; night trips will only be
conducted in an emergency).
The drill ship will be supported by two (2) PSVs and one (1) fast boat. It is
estimated that six (6) supply trips per week will be required to transport
materials and supplies from Balikpapan to the drill ship. Supplies (eg. diesel
fuel, drill water, etc) required throughout drilling operations will be supplied
from the POSB.
Typical vessel and manning requirements during drilling are summarized in
Table 2-3.
Table 2-3
Vessel
Requirements
Drill Rig

Vessel & Manning Requirements during Drilling


No. of People
on Board
140 max

Fuel Consumption
63 m3/ day (during transit to
drill locations)
40 m3/ day during drilling
10 tonnes/ day
10 tonnes/ day

2 x PSVs
20 (10 each)
1 x Fast Boat
8
Notes:
[1] For all three wells, including mobilization/ demobilization

2.4

Total Duration of
Operation [Note 1] (Days)
165

6 trips per week


165

DRILL SHIP SPECIFICATIONS


Drill ships are special purpose - built ships which consist of all the equipment
that you would find on a conventional drilling rig. A summary of the
principal drill ship specifications is provided below and summarized in the
following subsections:

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-8

2.4.1

Storage facilities for drill water, potable water, fuel oil, liquid mud, sack
storage, bulk materials and cement;

Drilling equipment consisting of a derrick, rotary table, top drive,


drawworks, mud pumps, pipe handling system, solids controls, blowout
preventor (BOP) stack, well control systems and equipment;

Four cranes for materials handling (two rated at 65 tons and two at 25
tonnes capacity);

Flare boom attachment positions for well test flaring operations; and

Electrical power generation system nine diesel fuel engines and one
diesel emergency generator set.

Storage facilities
A summary of storage facilities provided on the GSF Explorer is shown in
Table 2-4.
Table 2-4

2.4.2

Bulk Storage Facilities

Material

Storage Capacity

Fuel (diesel)
Drilling mud
Base oil
Sack storage
Bulk (barite/ bentonite)
Cement

48,380 bbls
1,429 bbls (active system), 4,800 bbls (reserve system)
1, 618 bbls
7,000 sx
36,000 cubic feet: 10 tanks (3,600 cubic feet each)
11,130 cubic feet: 6 tanks (1,855 cubic feet each)

Electrical Power Generation


The main power generation system consists of nine diesel generators (five at
4900 HP and four at 3070 HP). Fuel consumption is about 40 m3/day during
drilling operations (including on standby). Diesel will be supplied from the
POSB.
An emergency diesel engine driven generator is also provided to power
essential loads during abnormal operations.

2.4.3

Cooling Water and Drilling Water Supply


Seawater will be used for cooling the ship engines while drill water will be
supplied from the POSB at Balikpapan.

2.4.4

Sewage Treatment
All grey water (includes laundry, kitchen, bathroom faucets, baths and
showers) generated on board the drill ship will not pass the Omnipure but
will be discharged overboard into the sea.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-9

Toilets flushing water in the Explorer Drilling Ship get its water directly from
sea water suplly line. Black water (i.e. waste water from toilets) will be
treated in the Omnipure. The treated balck water will be discharged directly
overboard into the sea .
2.4.5

Drainage System
Areas that contain oil will be drained to a storage tank for shipment to and
disposal on shore. Rainwater in clean areas will be drained into the sea.

2.5

DRILLING SCHEDULE
Exploration drilling activities are proposed to begin in early January to
February for the first and second well, and in July 2011 for the third well. It is
estimated that the drilling of each well will take approximately < 60 days.
The estimated duration of drilling for each well is provided in Table 2-5.
Table 2-5

Proposed Drilling Schedule

Activity

Duration (days)*

Drilling of well 1
Drilling of well 2
Drilling of well 3
Total

54
56
55
165

Note:
* Includes mobilization/ transit to each well

2.6

EMISSIONS, DISCHARGES, WASTE & NOISE EMISSIONS


This section provides an estimated inventory of air emissions, discharges to
sea and wastes generated during key project activities. It should be noted
that emissions and discharge data should be taken to be indicative and
preliminary in nature. Assumptions, where used, have been made on a
conservative basis.

2.6.1

Air Emissions
The principal emissions to atmosphere during exploration drilling will
comprise products of combustion discharged from the power generation
equipment on the drill ship. Other air emission sources will include:

Supply and support vessel exhausts;

Helicopter flights;

Fugitive emissions of hydrocarbons from a range of sources including fuel


bunkering/ transfer operations, drill mud de-gassing etc.

Particulate (dust) emissions during bulk materials transfer operations (eg.


barite, cement etc. loading) from the bulk handling system vents;

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-10

Releases of ozone depleting substances (ODS) during maintenance of


HVAC systems as well as from fugitive sources associated with such
equipment.

An estimated emissions inventory for key sources is presented in Table 2-6.


Table 2-6
Source

Drilling Air Emissions


Emission (MT) (Total for Drilling Campaign)
CO2

N2O

NOX

SO2

CO

CH4

Drilling Ship*
17,952
1.2
392.7
56.1
106.6
0.8
PSVs **
5,209.4
0.36
9.60
16.28
30.93
0.44
Fast Boat***
5,280.0
0.36
9.74
16.50
31.35
0.45
Helicopters
77.7
0.01
0.14
0.24
0.46
0.01
28,519
2.0
412
89
169
2.0
Total
Notes
* Drill ship on site for total of 165 days for all three wells
** Assuming 6 trips for both PSVs to drill site each week
*** Assuming on site for total of 165 days
Fuel use assumed based on (Auris, 1995; IP, 2000; EPA, 2000a; EPA, 2000b)
Fuel sulphur content 0.5 wt%

NMHC

CO2-eq

10.7
3.09
3.14
0.05
17

18,351
5,330
5,402
78
29,161

Drilling emissions are estimated to generate a total of 29,161 tonnes of CO2-eq.


This represents 0.001% of Indonesias total CO2 emissions1.
2.6.2

Discharges to Sea

2.6.2.1

Mud & Cuttings Disposal


The well will be drilled using WBM and SBM; during WBM drilling,
generated drill cuttings and spent WBM will be discharged to seabed. Excess
cement will also be discharged into the sea. During drilling with SBMs, the
only discharge of SBM to the sea will arise due to drill mud retained on
cuttings after drying in the cuttings dryer system to an oil level content to
around 30 50 g/kg or 3-5%. Ministry of Energy and Mineral Resources
Regulation No 045 Year 2006 sets forth allowable limit of oil content in drill
cuttings for offshore drilling. In accordance with this regulation, drill cuttings
can be disposed to the sea (in non-sensitive areas, type of sensitive areas are
defined in Presidential Decree No 32 Year 1990) if the oil content in drill
cuttings is less than 10% (10 g/kg). Statoil has internal policy the oil content
in drill cuttings that can be disposed to the sea is no more than 1%, if this
limit can not be fulfilled during drilling, the project will search a dispensation
from Statoil corporate head quarter to allow to dispose drill cuttting with oil

(1) 1 Indonesias total annual CO2 emissions stand at 3.014 billion tonnes (Indonesias Worlds No. 3 Greenhouse Gas
Emitter: Report, Adhityani Arga. 4 June 2007. http://www.reuters.com/article/idUSJAK26206220070604)

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-11

content higher than 1% but no more than 10% to the sea; if not the drill
cutttings will be transported to shorebase in Balikpapan for further process.
The estimated volumes of cuttings discharged are indicated in Table 2-7.
Table 2-7

Estimated Volumes of Cuttings Discharged

Components
Open Hole
Diameter
Fluid Type
Cuttings
discharge (m3)
Total (m3)

2.6.2.2

36

Estimated Cuttings Volume for each Well Section


26
20
17.5
13.25
12.25
8.5

WBM WBM SBM


SBM
SBM
SBM
SBM
151
1
71
78
53
30
15
30

WBM
66
218

6
SBM
5

252

Cement Disposal
Cement is usually prepared on board the drill rig in marginally greater
quantity than is expected to be required. Left-over cement is typically
discharged overboard. The estimated volume of cement to be used and
discharged from the Karama drilling programme is:
Components
Open Hole
Diameter ()
Cement Volume to
be used (m3)
Excess cement (%)
Excess cement

2.6.2.3

Estimated Cement Volume for each Well Section


30
26
20
17.5 13.25
12.25

36

(m3)

8.5

48 (base),
59 (down
hole)
200

221
(base), 20

47

26

100 & 20

30

30

214

225

14.1

7.8

Wastewater Discharges
Other discharges to sea from the drill ship, standby and support vessels will
comprise bilge water, cooling water, deck drainage, sewage and grey water
(eg laundry/showers etc.). Indicative sewage and domestic wastewater
discharge rates for typical offshore operations are presented in Table 2-8.
Table 2-8
Type of Vessel

Estimated Volumes of Operational Discharges to Sea


Duration

No. of Personnel
Onboard

Discharges to Sea (m3)


Domestic Effluent
(Grey Water)

1 X Drill ship
165
140
2,541
2 X PSVs
141
20
310
1 X Fast Boat
165
8
145
Total
168
2,996
Data Sources/ Assumptions:
Domestic effluent generation rate 0.11 m3/person/day
Sewage generation rate 0.075 m3/person/day

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

Sewage
(Black Water)
1,733
212
99
2,043

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-12

2.6.3

Hazardous and Non-hazardous Waste Generation


Drilling activities generate a variety of non-hazardous and hazardous wastes.
A waste handling and storage procedure is implemented on board the GSF
Explorer and, with the exception of grey water, kitchen wastes and drilling
waste (drill cuttings) which will be treated and disposed of into the sea, all
other waste types will be returned to shore for disposal.
A list of typical wastes potentially generated during drilling is presented in
Table 2-9.
Table 2-9

Typical Development Drilling Wastes

Non-hazardous

Galley (food) waste

Garbage (paper, packaging, rags, plastic, glass)

Wooden crates, pallets and timber cuts

Sacks and bags

Containers and drums (metal & plastic)

Scrap metal (ferrous & non-ferrous)


Hazardous

Drums & containers contaminated with oil, chemicals etc.

Lube oil, grease, hydraulic fluids

Paints, thinners and coating products

Solvents and de-greasers

Slop oil (oil/water mixture)

Oily rags and other inert oil contaminated materials

Off-spec chemicals

2.6.4

Noise
Noise emissions associated with the project will be generated by the drill
ship, support and supply vessels. Helicopter flights will also be a further
source of transient noise.
Drill ship noise will be generated by the ships engines, propellers and
thrusters, power generation equipment, pumps, shale shakers, draw-works,
hydraulic power packs, cranes, air compressors etc.). Noise from support
shipping (ie. the PSVs and fast boat) will be generated by the engines,
propellers and thrusters.
Noise level generated by using dynamic positioning is indicated at
196 dB/1mPa at frequencies between 20 25 kHz. Indicative underwater
noise frequencies, source levels and attenuation levels associated with a drill
ship are presented in Table 2-10. For comparison sake, noise frequencies,
source levels and attenuation levels for other offshore activities are also listed.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-13

Recorded underwater noise levels at source for supply and support vessels
range between 186 191 dB re 1 Pa (SEIC, 2005)2.
Table 2-10

Sound Sources from Various Maritime Activities

Activity

Frequency
Range
(kHz)

Average
Source Level
(dB re 1mPa-m

Estimated Received Level at Different


Ranges (km) by Spherical Spreadinga
0.1 km
1 km
10 km
100 km

Drill ship
Jack-up drilling rig
Production drilling
Semi-submersible rig
Large merchant
vessel
Military Vessel
Super tanker

0.01 - 10
0.005 - 1.2
0.25
0.016 - 0.2
0.005 - 0.9

167 - 171
163
85 - 127
179 - 191

127 131
123
208
45 87
139 151

106 - 110
102
187
24 - 66
118 - 130

0.02 - 0.1

160 - 190
190 - 203

120 150
150 163

99 - 129
129 - 142

81 - 85
77
162
<41
93 - 105

6 - 10
2
87
0
18 - 30

74 - 104
<29
104 29 - 42
117
Notes: In water the decibel scale is used with a reference pressure of 1 Pa, as opposed to 20 Pa in
air
Adapted from: Evans & Nice, 1996; Richardson et al, 1995

(2) 2 Sakhalin Energy Investment Company LTD. Comparative Environmental Analysis of the Piltun-Astokh Field
Pipeline Route Options, 2005.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

2-14

CHARACTERIZATION OF THE INFLUENCED AREA

3.1

PETROSEA OFFSHORE SUPPLY BASE (POSB)


PSOB is located in and as part of the integrated Tanjung Batu Harbour in
Balikpapan. This area is far from the residential area and has had an
Integrated AMDAL and Environmental-based Development Feasibility Study
by Ministry of Environment Decree No. 545/2007 for Offshore Supply Base
activities.
PSOB is located far from the residential area therefore it will be likely less
interaction with the community in Balikpapan. In terms of environmental
impacts, it will be into the operational mode when drilling activities occurs in
Karama Blocks. This will include liquid mud plant operation, tubular
maintenance and harbour operation. Most of the activities are conducted
within the supply base accept to those of shipping operations to Karama
Block.
All environmental impacts will be managed and monitor within the supply
base in Balikpapan. Petrosea has developed standard operation procedure for
environmental management to be enacted to ensure that the POSB meets
contractual, legal and environmental requirements. Further, this is also to
meet the requirements of ISO 14001:2004 which include the need of continual
improvements. These SOPs include: Waste Management Procedure (POSBHSE-PR-G-0005), Environmental Management Plan for Tanjung Batu Supply
Base (POSB-HSE-PL-G-0002) and POSB Waste Management Plan (POSB-HSEPL-G-0002).
The environmental and social components baseline of the area excerpted
from Integrated AMDAL of PSOB document, are as follow:

3.1.1

Climate
Data on climatic conditions in the Balikpapan during the period from 2000 to
2005 was obtained from the Meteorological and Geo-physics station of
Sepinggan, Balikpapan City. Data includes temperature, humidity, rainfall
and wind speed and direction. The data shows that this region has a tropical
climate of A type, with average rainfall > 204.8 mm/month.

3.1.1.1

Air Temperature
The highest average temperature occurred in April May, accounting for
34.5oC and minimum air temperature occurs in August, with the average of
21.4oC. The increase trend of temperature by year, is predicted as the result of
development, land clearing and illegal logging throughout Kalimantan.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-1

3.1.1.2

Humidity
In Balikpapan, the humidity is influenced by degree of evaporation caused by
hot air stream from sea surface or coast. Based on data from Sepinggan
Meteorological Station for period 2000-2005, the average humidity fluctuates
between 55% to 97% where the lowest occured in April and the highest is in
November.

3.1.1.3

Rainfall
The highest rainfall occured from September to January, with the monthly
average of 252.2 mm while the lowest occured in July with 160.7 mm in
average. The daily fluctuations may vary between one month to the other
month.

3.1.1.4

Wind speed and direction


Wind speed and direction in Balikpapan varies, depending on monsoon and
temporal condition (night or day).
Wind data from Balikpapan
Meteorological and Go-physics Station during 2000-2005 showed in general,
during rainy season, the wind blows from North-West for Southeast direction
while on dry season is mostly to Northeast direction. The highest wind
absolute velocity occured in May 2003 with 50 knots while the slowest of 14
knots, occured in April 2003. Speed and wind direction pattern affect the
monthly water flow movement in the Makassar Strait.

3.1.1.5

Bathymetry
The Tanjung Batu waters in Balikpapan Bay has a moderate slope os shallow
water until 0,5 mile and reaching 3 m deep in 0.6 mile from nearshore,
followed by 6-12 m deep at the range of 1 mile from shore. The depth is
relatively stable as the result of low sedimentation, represented by granite
boulders on the seabed and water clarity within 1 mile radius from shore.

3.1.1.6

Tide
Based on Balikpapan Port Authority analysis in 1984 (Stage II: Rehabilitation
of Balikpapan No. l Terminal) shows that the highest tide is 267 cm and the
lowest was 5 cm. the average of sea mean level during the observation was
135 cm. The analysis result also shows that Tanjung Batu waters has a mix
tide type with semidiurnal prevailing. High tide occurs twice in a day with
different range. Mean sea level was 1.40 m above the ebb line and high water
spring happens 2.8 m above the ebb line.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-2

3.1.1.7

Wave
Wave characteristic in Balikpapan Bay ranges from 1-1.5 m with wave period
of 6 seconds from south to Northwest. From previous study (Design report
on Urgent Development Program for the Port of Balikpapan, 1988), the waves
could reach 2.0 m, influenced by vessel movement in the port. However, all
vessels entering the Port should be guided and is not exceeding the
maximum speed of 3 knots to avoid hydrodynamics pattern shift within the
Port.

3.1.1.8

Coral Reef
Coral condition near the PSOB water in Tanjung Batu was in bad to moderate
condition (based on criteria in Ministry of Environment Decree No. KEP04/MENLH/02/2001). Based on the AMDAL study in 3 locations in Tanjung
Batu waters, the coral cover was 21.26% to 34.59%. It is predicted that the
dead coral and rubble, have been resulted from un-environmentally practices
from local fishers, using cyanide and bomb for fishing. These practices have
been enacted by the local fishers as the dead coral has been covered by algae.
However, some species has been survived in the location, including Acropora
spp, Fungia spp, and Lobophyllia. Based on fact that water quality surrounding
the area and unsustainable development in the Tanjung water, the coral
ecosystem recovery does not likely to occurs.

3.1.1.9

Fisheries
Balikpapan Bay has a great potential of the fisheries development, including
aquaculture (fish and shrimp ponds; floating cage) and capture fisheries. The
existing activities include the development of ponds for growing the tiger
prawn (Penaeus monodon) and milky fish (Chanos chanos).
The fisheries resources in Balikpapan has not been fully exploited. The
maximum sustainable yield of Balikpapan water is predicted to reach 16.36
tonnes/year but the fishing utilization has been only 1.25 tonnes/month
(Balikpapan Fisheries Agency, 1998). The yield from mariculture from fish
and shrimp ponds activities (tambaks) is 8.6 tonnes/year and 1.25
toones/year for tiger prawn and milk fish respectively. On capture fisheries,
some economically important fishes are found in the area: sardines, groupers,
trevally and snappers. This indicates that Balikpapan Bay is also important
habitat for some economic valued fishes.

3.1.2

Socio Economy and Cultural


Social-cultural-economic data included for the West Balikpapan sub-district,
which is focused on Kelurahan Kariangau, covering the area of 175.3275

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-3

km2, as this village is adjacent to the POSB and Tanjung Batu Port. In general,
the Kariangau villagers earn the living from fishing, farming and servicing.
3.1.2.1

Demography
The Balikpapan Barat monographs (2006) reported the population of
Kariangau was 3.050 people, living in most of the 97% of this sub district area.
Residence density was the lowest from all subdistricts in Balikpapan,
accounting for 17 people/km2. Household composition is on the average of 4
people per family, i.e father, mother and 2 children.
Sex ratio in this Subdistrict is dominated by man with the percentage of 100
to 117,70. The productive age is 82% of the population, representing that 33 of
non productive person is under responsibility of 152 productive workers.
Ethnic composition are dominated by Bugis-Makasarese, Torajan and
Butonese and some are Javanaese. The people from Sulawesi are mostly
working as workers in logging companies while the Javanese are more into
servicing activities, such as opening restaurants and as traders.

3.1.2.2

Economic Activities
Livelihood of local community in Balikpapan Barat sub district are mostly
fisherman, followed by government employee and labour at port. Few of
them are working in Army and in private sectors. Most of the village dweller
are highly dependent on the local natural resources as part of their economic
activities. This can be shown in the composition of the villagers: fisherman
28% and farmer, aquaculture fisher, seaweed farmer are 2% each; while
labour and army are 6% and 2% respectively, from the total dwellers.
Unemployment in this subdistrict is categorized the lowest, accounted for
16% of the total population.
The fisheries activities, capture and aquaculture, are the major livelihood in
Kariangau village, as of 30% of the villagers are still depending on this
natural resources. However, this livelihood will be highly impacted due to
the development PSOB. In the last 5-10 years, the fishing yield has been
declining by 24%, from IDR 19,285,714 to IDR 14,571,285. Interview
conducted with the local communities during the PSOB AMDAL study
revealed that the decline was as the result of pollution from some industrial
activities nearby, combined with high and busy marine traffic in Balikpapan
bay. Some exclusive zones by the industries are also limit the resources
access. This is worsened by the increase of the fuel price.

3.1.2.3

Community perception
Community perception on the PSOB activities are mostly positive. Based on
the surveyed conducted during the AMDAL study showed that 96% of the

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-4

total villagers supported the development of the shorebase facilities while


villagers who was against or skeptical of the facilities development was
accounted for 2% each. The villagers who agreed with this new development
put a great expectation on the employment with PSOB while on the other
side, the community who was against to PSOB development had a serious
concern on the impact of the PSOB development on their livelihood, such as
deterioration of their environment and livelihood quality.
3.2

PROJECT LOCATION FOR DRILLING ACTIVITY-KARAMA BLOCK


Karama Block is located in the Mamuju Regency in the Makassar Strait,
offshore West Sulawesi (Figure 1-1). The baseline description describes the
environmental and social characteristics in the area, focusing on the project
Zone of Influence (ZOI) which was determined from modeling the potential
impact from the proposed exploration drilling program. In addition,
consideration is also given to characteristics in the area of Balikpapan
relevant to supply/support activities for the program as described above.

3.2.1

Defining the Project Zone of Influence


Drill cutting dispersion and oil spill modeling were used to predict the area of
potential impact from the deep-water exploration drilling program under
routine and non routine conditions. Detailed results from the models are
provided in Appendix 1. In summary, oil spill modeling highlighted the
areas of Karampuang Island and adjacent shoreline of the Mamuju Regency
of West Sulawesi as vulnerable to an accidental release of hydrocarbons
under certain scenarios (Figure 3-1). The known sensitive receptors in these
areas include coral reef; mangrove and sea grass ecosystems; and community
brackish water fish ponds (tambak) as discussed in the following sections.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-5

Figure 3-1

Project Zone of Influence)

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-6

3.2.2

Meteorology
Climate data is provided for the Mamuju Regency. Average temperature is
25-28C where the maximum temperature ranges from 31 to 34C and the
minimum temperature ranges from 20 to 24C (Mamuju in Numbers, 2008).
The area has a high occurrence of rainfall with only 0-2 dry months a year.
Rainfall levels are highest from November to March with average rainfall is
4,000 mm, while from June to October average rainfall is 1,400 mm. Average
humidity of the Mamuju Regency is between 75 to 80% (West Sulawesi in
Numbers, 2005-2006).
Local meteorological data (winds) were obtained from the Asia Pacific Data
Research Center (APDRC) for coordinates 118.6 E Longitude, 2.1 S Latitude.
While both March and October had significant winds from the east and west,
wind rose diagrams (Figure 3-2) showed an additional strong influence of
winds from the southwest in March 2008 and from the northeast in October.
Average wind velocity ranges from 5 to 16 km/hour. Maximum wind
velocity is typically 29-67 km/hour.

3.2.3

Tectonics and Geology


The Makassar Strait occupies the continental shelf, slope and rise areas
between the islands of Kalimantan and Sulawesi, forming a distinct
physiographic border between the western Indonesia landmass and the
eastern Indonesia archipelago. The strait is roughly 100200 km wide and
300 km long.
The Makassar Strait is bounded towards the north by a long lateral fault (the
Palu-Koro fault), which separates this basin from the Sulawesi sea. The
Makassar Strait is divided into the North Makassar and South Makassar basin
by another lateral fault (Paternoster fault). The occurrence of these two faults
is clearly reflected by the steep gradients indicated by the bathymetric
contours. A thick sequence of relatively undisturbed Neogene and probably
Paleogene sediments showing good lateral continuity were deposited in the
basin (Darman, 2000).

3.2.4

Oceanography
The Makassar Straits are the main passage in the transfer of water and heat
from the Pacific to the Indian Ocean, via the Indonesian seas. This transfer of
Pacific water into the Indian Ocean through the Indonesian seas affects the
heat and freshwater budgets of both oceans as well as having an effect on
global climate (Ffield, et al., 2000).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-7

Figure 3-2

Windrose in the study area (left March 2008 and right October 2008 windrose)

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-8

3.2.4.1

Bathymetry
The Makassar Strait is bounded by the Sulawesi Sea to the north and the East
Java Sea to the south. The southern part of the strait is shallower than the
north, with average water depths less than 2 km. Water depths at the
proposed exploration well locations in the Karama Block range from
approximately 1,650 m closest to the coast to 1,900 m at the western-most well
location.

Figure 3-3

3.2.4.2

Bathymetry of Karama Block

Seawater Temperature and Salinity (density)


Sea surface temperature (SST) and sea surface salinity (SSS) in the Karama
PSC vary seasonally and annually due to Monsoon Wind Systems and the
Indonesian Trough Flow (ITF) (Ilahude and Gordon 1996). SST also varies
geographically from north to south.
Surveys show that during the South East Monsoon (SEM), SST is slightly
colder (28.2 28.7C) and SSS is higher (33.8 34.2 psu) (Prisetiahadi, 1994
and Ilahude and Gordon 1996). SST is slightly colder in the southern part of
the Strait (around 28 C) compared to the middle and northern part (about
28-29 C) during SEM. From east-west SST is relatively constant, especially in
the middle part of the strait. This warm SST is considered as a part of warm
pool of tropical Pacific Ocean.
The SSS is above 34.11 psu (about 34.2-34.5 psu) during the SEM. The values
of SSS in the southern part are slightly higher and homogenous than those at
the middle and northern part of Strait.
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-9

During the North West Monsoon (NWM), SST is about 0.8C higher, with
values between 29.1 30.0 C. As during the SEM, the SST in the southern
part of the strait is colder than those at the northern part. The SSS is slightly
lower (31.6 - 33.8 psu) during the NEM than those during the SEM (Ilahude
and Gordon 1996 and Kusbiandary, 2000). These values are reduced
considerably during the NEM, especially in the middle part where SSS is
about 2.6 psu less that those during the SEM.
The vertical distribution of temperature and salinity within and around
Karama Block, Makassar Strait also varies seasonally. During the SEM, the
surface mixed layers extend to 25 to 60 m depth and deeper toward the
southern part of the strait. The thermocline is seen from 60 m to depths of
225 to 300 m. The temperatures at these layers decrease from 27C to 10/12C.
Beyond 300 m water depth temperature decrease slowly to about 6C at a
depth of 1000 m.
Vertical salinity profiles during the SEM show that salinity increases from
about 33.8-33.8 psu at the surface to 34.5-34.7 psu at a depth of 100-150 m.
Seawater at this depth is believed to be of North Pacific origin and is called
North Pacific Subtropical Water (NPSW). Beyond this depth salinity
decreases to 34.0- 34.6 psu at 250-450 m (North Pacific Intermediate Water
(NPIW)) and approximately 34.5 psu at 1000 m (Wyrtki, 1961; Prisetiahadi,
1994; and Ilahude and Gordon 1996). Indicative vertical temperature and
salinity profiles during SEM are depicted in Figure 3-4.

Figure 3-4

Vertical profile at Makassar Strait (a) Temperature (b) Salinity

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-10

During the NWM, the surface mixed layer extends to 50 - 60 m depth and
water temperature is 28 C, falling to 12C in the thermocline layer to 250 m.
Below this layer to water depths of 1000m, the temperature falls to 5C. The
vertical profile of salinity during NWM displays a salinity increase to about
34.6-34.8 psu at the depth of 120-200 m (NPSW). Below this depth, salinity
displays a minimum value of less than 34.45 psu at a depth of 300-400 m
(NPIW) (Wyrtki, 1961, Ilahude and Gordon 1996 and Kusbiandary, 2000).
Horizontal mean monthly SST and SSS within and around Karama Block
computed from data for the period 1929 to 2004 (available from NODC,
NOAA, USA and JODC, Japan) show similar values. The mean monthly SST
around the Karama Block varied from 28C to 30.3C and was slightly colder
during the SEM than the NWM. Mean monthly SSS are slightly lower during
the NWM (January and February) with the values of 30.5 33 psu, and
slightly higher (32.2 34.5 psu) during the SEM (July and August). At both
seasons, surface salinity at the Karama Block consistently shows a decrease
towards the coast. This may be attributable to river drainage from the land
into the nearshore waters.
3.2.4.3

Ocean Currents (Direction and Velocity Horizontal and Vertical Profile)


The description of Ocean Currents within the Karama Block, Makassar Strait
is based on:

In situ current data set from JODC, Japan from alternate year starting
from 1902 to 1997 (JODC, 2009).

A three year dataset of ocean currents within Labani Channel, a 45 km


constriction near 252S (Susanto and Gordon, 2005; Gordon, 2008),
approximately 30 nm south-southwest of the center of the Karama block.

The results of ocean models developed at the US Naval Research


Laboratory (NRL, 2009).

Visual observation of horizontal distributions of monthly mean current


vectors within Karama Block show that the currents vary in speed and
direction temporally and spatially (Table 3-1). The characters of ocean
currents in the Makassar Strait and within Karama Block are consistent with
the results of Naval Research Laboratory model as mentioned by Gordon
(2008). The main flows are mainly toward south-southeast especially in the
west of the Karama Block. During certain months such as March and
December (see Table 3-1) eddies occur especially at eastern site of Karama
Block closed to the coast in which the flows directed toward northeast- north.
Such eddies were also found in the results of the US Naval Research
Laboratory (NRL, 2009)
The stick plot of the current vector at MAK I (west mooring) measured
during Arlindo experiment at Labani Channel is presented in Figure 3-5
(Susanto and Gordon 2005). The length of the stick equates to the value of the
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-11

speed of the current and the angle of the stick measured from the upward
vertical line (i.e. north direction) is the direction of the current vector. The
speed and direction of the surface currents shown in Figure 3-5 are consistent
with those mean monthly surface ocean current presented in Table 3-1. The
maximum speed was found at the thermocline layer and current direction
was mainly south-southeast to south east.

0.15 0.2 0.25 0.3 0.35 0.4 0.45 0.5 0.55 0.6 0.65 0.7 0.75 0.8 0.85

Figure 3-5

Stick plot of the current vector at several depths at MAK I (west


mooring) measured during Arlindo experiment at Labani Channel from
July 2005 June 2006.

Table 3-1

Variation of mean monthly surface current vector within Karama


Block from January to December

Month
January
February
March

Speed
(m/sec)
0.1 0.2
0.15 -0.3
0.15 0.4

Direction

Description

South, southeast
South, south-southeast
South, southeast, east,
northeast, north

Weaker at coastal side


Almost homogeneous spatially
Eddy counter clockwise,
southward at seaside and
northward at the coast
Irregular motion, very slow in the
center
Slightly stronger at coastal site

April

0.05 0.2

May

0.2 0.5

June

0.05 0.4

Northeast, northnortheast
South, southsoutheast, southsouthwest
South, west, southwest

July

0.15 0.4

South, southwest

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

Stronger southward at coast,


weaker in middle westsouthwestward
Weaker at the sea site

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-12

Month

3.2.4.4

August

Speed
(m/sec)
0.05 0.15

September
October

0.3 0.4
0.2 0.35

November

0.35 0.95

December

0.25 0.35

Direction
West, southwest,
south-southwest
South, south-southeast
South, southsouthwest
Northwest, southeast
Southeast, east,
northeast

Description
Weaker at the coast and the
middle
Relatively homogenous spatially
Weaker in the middle
Chaos and strong current in the
center
Current flows southeast from sea
site and northeast at the coast

Waves (Direction, Period and Significant Height)


Wave data used to describe wave characteristics within the Karama Block are
the results of model output of European Climate Moderate Range Weather
Forecast (ECMWF). The wave model output series (19892008) which are
available in a north-south section along 118.5 E starting from -1.5S to -3S is
at western edge of Karama Block and is presented in Figure 3-6. The time
series of wave characteristics along this section show that during 1989 to 2002
the significant wave height varied between 0.3 to <0.4 m and at the same
period, the mean wave period is varied between >4 sec to >4.5 sec. However,
from 2003 to 2008, the significant wave height increased to 0.4 m to 0.45 m
and the mean wave period also increased to 5 sec to 5.25 sec. Moreover, the
direction of mean wave is varied between 180 degrees to 200 degrees (south
to south-southeastward) from 1989 to 2008, except in November 1997 to
August 1998 where the mean wave direction is 100 degrees to 150 degrees
(south-southwest).
The time series wave characteristics from March 2008 to February 2009 are
also available from ECMWF) at a station just north and south of the Karama
Block. At the station north of Karama Block, the significant wave heights
fluctuated mainly around 0.3 to 0.4 m, period mainly 4.2 to 6.5 sec and
direction mainly around 200 degrees to 250 degrees (south west). At the
station south of the Karama Block, the wave data show a greater fluctuation
than those at the north station.
The significant wave height is 0.3 to 0.5 m in March 2008 April, then starts
to increase reaching a highest value of 0.7 - 0.9 m in July 2008; decreasing to
about 0.3 -0,.4 m in December 2008 and fluctuating abruptly in January and
February 2009. The mean wave period is varied between 4.5 to 6.5 sec in
March to May 2008, 5.0 5.4 sec in June to September 2008 and 4.5 to 6.5 sec
from October 2008 to February 2009. Wave directions are varied between
150 degrees (south-southwest) in March to October 2008 to
200 degrees-250 degrees (turning slightly to the west) in November 2008 to
February 2009.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-13

The impact of storm events can not be seen from the results of the ECMWF
model output in 1989-2008 (Figure 3-6) and March 2008 to February 2009.
The reason for this is that the wind data used to predict the wave height
represent weekly averaged winds. Consequently, storm events which
usually take place over a relatively short duration are averaged out.

Figure 3-6

3.2.4.5

Time series of wave characteristics: (i) significant wave height (upper),


(ii) mean wave period (middle), and (iii) mean wave direction (lower)
along a north-south section acquired from European Climate
Moderate Range Weather Forecast (ECMWF)

Tide Regime
Tide data records are available from measurement (122 April 2009) at
Mamuju (118.91667 E - 2.68333 S) just south of Karama Block coast and as
predicted data using a Global Tidal Model and Nested Regional Tidal Model
(BPPT) validated with surface height measured by Topex/Poseidon, ERS-1
and ERS-2. The results of this model can be acquired at many locations
around Karama Block such as those at the northern and southern parts of the
Karama Block.
A comparison between tide measurements and the results of the tide
prediction model at Mamuju is provided in Figure 3-7. The results of tide
prediction using admiralty methods compare very well with those of tide
measurement. The results show that the type of tide in Mamuju and Karama
Block is mixed and predominantly semi-diurnal. This means that there 2
distinct high and low water occurrences a day (24 hours) but the tidal range
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-14

between these two events is significantly different for neap and spring tides.
During the time of measurement at Mamuju (122 April 2009) the tidal range
varied between 0.74 m during the neap tide (5 April 2009) to 1.83 m during
the spring tide (12 April 2009), while the predicted tide at the Karama Block
over the period 131 May 2009 shows a varying range between 0.4 m during
neap tide to 2.1 m during spring tide. Both sets of results are comparable and
a similar tide regime has been reported by earlier studies for the Makassar
Strait in Wyrtki, 1961.

Figure 3-7

3.2.4.6

Comparison between tide measurement (blue) and results of tide


prediction (red) at Mamuju from 1 22 April 2009.

Characterization of Extreme Conditions (Storms) (Winds, Waves and Currents).


Extreme conditions are usually caused by storms. As storms pass by, then
wind will be stronger, wave height will be higher, wave periods will be
longer and may it cause chaotic and strong surface currents. There is limited
wave model prediction data for storm conditions in the Makassar Strait. This
report describes some of the available data on extreme wind conditions which
may be considered as storms.
Methods of observation and modelling to produce the wind data include:

Satellite Dataset,

Merge Optimal Interpolation (IO) Dataset,

Model output from Cersat IFREMER, France and

Validation from BMGK Data set.

Wind conditions in the Makassar Strait were characterized from the above
sources for the period 1 to 24 April 2009 with 4 wind condition each day (at
hours of 00.00, 06.00, 12.00 and 18.00). Visual observation of this period at 4
times each day showed moderate wind conditions within or nearby the
Karama Block. These include:

April 2009 at 00.06 hours where the wind speed was >9 m/sec to the
southwest.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-15

13 April 2009, 06.00 with a location just north of Karama Block, where the
wind speed was 6.5 m/sec with an eastward direction.

17 April 2009, 00.60 at locations in the northern and eastern part of the
Karama Block where wind speed was 6.5 7.0 m/sec with an eastward
direction.

During April 2009, extreme wind conditions around the Karama Block were
infrequent but several occurrences were observed at the eastern side of
Makassar Strait, especially around the Balikpapan coast.
The occurrence of storms (wind speed > 20 m/s) in the Makassar Strait is
infrequent. This influenced by the location of the Strait at the equator and the
shielding effect of Kalimantan and Sulawesi. Furthermore, this area lies
between two tropical storm belts (generally located between 527 N and S
latitudes). The area is largely unaffected by tropical cyclones and is
characterized by localized squalls (Gill, 1982). Extreme events are rare but
monsoon storm events have been recorded and winds up to 80 miles/hr
(approximately 36 m/s) have occurred in exceptional circumstances.
3.2.5

Water and Sediment Quality


Water quality within the Karama Block was studied through sea water
column sampling conducted by ELNUSA during the period September to
October 2009. Sediment samples were also taken during the period. Water
quality sampling were conducted at three sampling locations as presented in
Figure 3-8 (one near the shoreline-point 4, and two located offshore-points 1B
and 2). Water samples were collected from different depth, resulting fourteen
sampling station (1B-a, 1B-b, 1B-c1, 1B-c2, 1B-d, 1B-e, 2-a, 2-b, 2-c1, 2-c2, 2-d,
2-e, 4-a, 4-b).

3.2.5.1

Water Quality
Seawater samples were collected from the following depths in the water
column:

Surface water sample at 10m;

Surface-mid water sample at 400m;

Mid water column sample at 620m;

Middle-bottom water sample at 1,200m; and

Bottom water sample at 1,600m.

The water quality of surrounding project location is largely in compliance to


Seawater standard regulated in Minister of Environment Decree No. 51 of
2004. Detailed results from the water quality analyses are provided in
Appendix 2.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-16

The sea water was physically clear, with high light intensity at the surface
and turbidity and Total Suspended Solid (TSS) values well below the
standards threshold. Temperatures were relatively warm at the surface,
which are in average double of the temperatures at depths.
Dissolved Oxygen (DO) at the surface of all sampling stations was slightly
lower than the standard threshold. This may be attributable to the relatively
higher temperature driving the equilibrium towards a gaseous phase. DO
also decrease with increasing depth due to less contact with the atmosphere.
There was a low level of Bio-chemical Oxygen Demand 5 Days (BOD5) as well
as non-detectable pollutant levels of Poly-cyclic Aromatic Hydrocarbon
(PAH), Poly Chlorinated Biphenyl (PCB), Tri Butyl Tin (TBT) and pesticides
in all of the samples.
The BOD concentration of the samples taken generally was below the
stipulated concentration stated in MoE 51-2004 that is 20 mg/L. This low
BOD is considered to show good condition where little pollution occurred at
the studied location. Influences of possible anthropogenic pollutants from
domestic activities (e.g. shipping and/or human activities at shores) were
indicated by the presence of phosphate, nitrate and surfactants, as well as oil
and grease parameters.
Total organic carbon (TOC) and total hydrocarbon were detected in all
sampling points. TOC representing all combustible organic compounds in
water was detected ranging from 0.69 to 3.74 mg/L. TOC is not regulated in
MoE 51-2004. Total hydrocarbon was detected in all sampling points ranged
from 0.4 t0 3.0 mg/L. In accordance with MoE 51-2004, threshold limit of
total hydrocarbon for marine water in port area is 1 mg/L, but total
hydrocarbon is not regulated for marine tourism and marine biota.
Oil and grease was detected in all sampling locations ranged from 2.2 to 7.0
mg/L. MoE 51-2004 stipulates threshold limit for marine water in port area is
5 mg/L and for marine tourism and marine biota is 1 mg/L. Based on this
limit, oil and grease concentrations in all samplings stations exceeded
threshold limit for marine tourism and marine biota.
Metals and heavy metals were generally in compliance with the standards,
except for Cr (VI), Pb and Ni. Cr (VI) was detected in all sampling locations
ranged from 0.009 to 0.130 mg/L (threshold limit 0.005 mg/L), Pb was
detected ranged from 0.194 to 0.300 mg/L (threshold limit 0.008 mg/L) and
Ni concentration in all sampling locations was detected ranged from 0.037 to
0.378 mg/L (threshold limit 0.05 mg/L). Other metals, such as Ba, Se, Al and
V have no standard threshold values. The concentrations had similar values
in all locations and depths, possibly because these metals are naturally
present in the sea water.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-17

Three type of radioisotops were analyzed from water samples during the
study i.e. 226Ra, 228Ra, and 210Pb. Radioactivity analytical result showed 210Pb
was detected in the range between <200 to 3900 mBq/L, while 226Ra was
detected ranging from 1.1 to 3.9 mBq/L and 228Ra ranged from 0.8 to 3.0
mBq/L. The radioactivity is considered well below the standard threshold
limit.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-18

Figure 3-8

Water column and sediment quality sampling locations

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-19

3.2.5.2

Sediment Quality
Sediment samples were collected in the same locations as water quality
samples (see Figure 3-8), consisted of near shoreline and off shore near the
Anoman Well.
Sediment characteristic of the project location based on the analysis of the
samples are classified as silt and silty-clay with low content of sand and
gravel. The near shoreline (location point 4) majority is silt, with some clay
and low sand content. Sediments near the Anoman well, location point 1B
and 2 are dominated by silt and clay with low content of sand.
Redox potential of the sediment samples showed positive value, ranging
from +68 to +115 mV. This value showed a good sign where the positive
redox potential means adequate oxygen presents in the vicinity. Data on
more than 1,000 samples of bottom deposits indicate Eh values ranging from
+350 to -500 mV have been observed in samples of recent sediments in which
the pH ranged from 6.4 to 9.5 (www.aapg.org). Positive Eh values are
generally characteristic of bottom deposits which are well oxygenated, those
which consist of coarse sediments, or those which are poor in organic matter.
Negative Eh values are characteristic of bottom deposits rich in organic
matter and which consist largely of fine sediments. An abundance of readily
decomposable organic matter appears to promote reducing conditions. In the
presence of organic matter, bacteria and allied microorganisms create
reducing conditions. Such conditions are maintained by certain organic
compounds, ferrous iron, reduced manganese, hydrogen sulphide, and other
inorganic constituents of sediment.
TOC (Total Organic Carbon) as an indicator of the organic matter content of a
system and the presence of food for benthic organisms ranged from 27.45 to
36.50%. No criteria is found in literature for optimal range of TOC in
sediment, as mentioned above there is a positive correlation between organic
content in the sediment and redox potential.
The metal content of sediment samples were of a similar range for each
sampling point. The highest levels of: Al, Fe, Pb, Cu, Ni, Cd, V, Co, Se and
Ag were recorded at sampling point 2; Ba, Hg, and Zn were higher at
sampling point 1B and Mn was highest at sampling point 4 (Appendix 3).
Currently, Indonesia does not have standard for sediment quality, the
analytical result is compared to OSPAR background concentration to have
information on sediment quality of the studied area.
Of the metals on the OSPAR BC list (Hg, Cd, Cr, Pb, As, Zn, Ni and Cu),
concentration of Hg at all sampling points was higher than OSPAR BC and
EAC limit while Ni and Cu were higher than OSPAR BC but still within the

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-20

OSPAR EAC limit. The concentration of Cr, Zn, and As was within the
OSPAR BC and OSPAR EAC limit.
3.2.6

Marine Flora and Fauna

3.2.6.1

Plankton
Aquatic biota samples were also collected during the water column/sediment
sampling program (three sampling location, fourteen sampling station 1B-a,
1B-b, 1B-c1, 1B-c2, 1B-d, 1B-e, 2-a, 2-b, 2-c1, 2-c2, 2-d, 2-e, 4-a, 4-b) as shown in
Figure 3-8.
Chlorophyll-a is the green pigment content that is produced by
phytoplankton and this can be used as an indication of the density of the
phytoplankton in the water. Analysis results (Appendix 2) confirmed that in
all samples, Chlorophyll-a was found to be between 0.21 (station #4-b) to
2.08mg/l (station #1B-c2). In general, the sampled sea water possessed a rich
plankton biomass but there was no indication of plankton blooms.
The analytical results (Appendix 2) showed maximum concentrations of
plankton at station #1B-a where 19,594 individuals/litre were recorded. In
stations #1B-d, #1B-e, #2-c1, #2-c2 and #2-d five classes of plankton
consisting of twenty seven species were found; phytoplankton
(Bacillariophyceae and Chromonadea) and zooplankton (Annelida, Cilliata
and Crustacea). Most of water samples originated from deep water (1,600 to
1,800 m). In such depths the low availability of light intensity prevents
abundance of phytoplankton. The most is Bacillariophyceae. The low
recorded level of BOD5 is also a factor affecting the amount of plankton.
Using the classification of biodiversity indices documented in Odum (1971)
low, intermediate and high biodiversity are indicated by Shannon indices of
<2.3, between 2.3 and 6.9 and >6.9. According to these criteria, five out of the
eight sampling station sampled fall in the low biodiversity category. Only
three out of eight sites fall into the intermediate biodiversity category. Six out
of the entire fourteen sites did not indicate presence of identified species. As
such, biodiversity diversity in the sampled sites is relatively low overall.
Given the results of the biomass analysis, this suggests the dominance of a
particular species.

3.2.6.2

Benthic Communities
Benthic analysis results of the sediment samples showed 30,698
individuals/m2 at sampling location 1B, 2,674 at sampling location 4 and no
individuals in location 2. Two classes were found; namely Bivalvia (Corbula,
Arctica, Bivalvia, Ensis, Cuspidaria and Thyassira) and Annelida (Polychaeta).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-21

All sampling locations displayed a low biodiversity based on Shannon


indices (Odum, 1971) that was below 2.3 (1.15 at location 1B; 0 at location 2
and 1.06 at location 4).
3.2.7

Fish

3.2.7.1

Eel (Anguilla sp)


Based on research conducted by LIPI (Lembaga Ilmu Pengetahuan
Indonesia/The Indonesian Institute of Sciences) from the research ship
Baruna Jaya VII in 2001, the Makassar Strait hosts important spawning areas
for eels. Eels spawning area near the Karama Block are more abundant in the
southern part than that in the north as showed in Figure 3-9.
Small eels have a spawning season around April-May, while the larger spawn
before April. Makasar Straits is a known spawning area for eels, but the most
significant spawning areas are in Tomini Bay out of the Karama Block area.
The eels spawning in the sea areas in the gulf then return to fresh water
around the Tomini Bay. The distribution of larval eels (leptochepalus)
correlates with the distribution of adult eels which inhabit freshwater
habitats.

3.2.7.2

Nener (milkfish larvae)


The coastal waters around West Sulawesi province (Sulawesi Barat) and
especially around Majene are spawning areas for nener (milkfish larval).
Milkfish larval abundance is estimated at 2 million larval per 2 km long beach
during the fishing season in March-April and August to January (Directorate
General of Fisheries 2007).

3.2.8

Marine Mammals
The oceanic conditions of the ALKI (Alur Laut Kepulauan
Indonesia/Indonesian Through Flow) through the Sulawesi and Makassar
Strait carried larvae and plankton from the Pacific to the Indian Ocean and is
likely to represent a migratory pathway for whales and dolphin species (Kreb
and Budiono, 2005). Studies along East Kalimantan marine water have found
an abundance of cetaceans and whilst data for the Makassar Strait and West
Sulawesi is limited it may be expected that cetaceans, especially dolphin
species may be encountered in the offshore waters of the Karama Block and
around adjacent islands. Offshore, such species may include the bottlenose
dolphin (Tursiops truncatus), spinner dolphin (Stenella longirostris), dwarf
spinner dolphin (Stenella l. roseiventris) and Indo-Pacific bottlenose dolphin
(Tursiops aduncus).
Nearshore and around islands, this may include
Irrawaddy dolphin, false killer whale (Pseudorca crassidens) and finless
porpoise (Neophocaena phocaenoides).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-22

Figure 3-9 Eel Spawning Area

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-23

3.2.9

Turtles
In Indonesia there are 6 species of sea turtles, green turtle (Chelonia mydas),
hawksbill turtle (Eretmochelys imbricata), leatherback turtle (Dermochelys
coriacea) olive ridley turtle (Lepidchelys olivacea), loggerhead turtle (Caretta
caretta) and flatback turtle (Natator depressa). All six sea turtle species existing
in Indonesia has been reserved No. 5 of 1990 concerning the Conservation of
Natural Resources and Ecosystem with Government Regulation No.
implementing regulations No. 7 of 1999 concerning The Preservation of
Plants and Animals.
A number of turtle species occur in the area of West Sulawesi and Makassar
Strait; the Leatherback (Dermochelys coriacea), Green (Chelonia mydas) and
Hawksbill turtle (Eretmochelys imbricate). All species of sea turtles are
endangered by the IUCN status. Turtle nesting sites are generally along the
fine sandy beaches, there are no reports of sea turtle nesting along the coast of
Mamuju. Turtle nesting season has a different time between places with one
another. In Indonesia turtle nesting season lasts all year round with peak
season vary by region. Turtle nesting season on the island of Sulawesi is
generally in the month of December to April.
Nesting beaches are outside of the area of the Karama Block and known
migration rotes suggest that the turtles concentrate along the coast of East
Kalimantan and South Sulawesi for nesting sites in the south and in the
waters in the North Makassar basin, north of Kalimantan and Sulawesi
(Figure 3-10). However, due to the location of the East Kalimantan breeding
sites these turtle species may be encountered in the vicinity of the Karama
Block and in the waters between Balikpapan and the PSC area.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-24

Figure 3-10

Sea Turtle Map

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-25

3.2.10

Sea Birds in Open seas and Coastal areas


The shallow, muddy coast of Sulawesi Barat has extensive mangrove forest,
which are regularly flooded with brackish or saline tidal waters. The plains,
mangroves, and mud flats have the potential to support vast numbers of
shorebirds. Sixty four (64) species of shorebirds have been recorded in
Indonesia, of which a few are not regularly observed. More than 34 species of
birds visit the Sulawesi beach twice each year. They can be seen between
February to April and between September to November, on the way to and
from breeding grounds in Northeast Asia and East Asia and also because of
the winter migration. The birds fly to southwestern Australia (White 1975)
between February to April and again between September to November.
These birds are often found in the muddy soil and beach along the coastline.
September to December is the migration season from the northern
hemisphere, which includes birds from the north mainland of Asia, Europe,
and America (Table 3-2). Indonesia represents a migration route and resting
area for these birds. The migrating birds also attract predators such as hawk
and eagle species which themselves migrate from the Malaya peninsula and
Philippines.
Table 3-2
No.

Some migratory birds in western Sulawesi (Holmes and Phillips, 1999)

Local Name

International Name

Scientific Name

Status

Dara laut kumis

Whiskered tern

Chilidonias hybridus

Least Concern

Dara laut sayap putih

White winged tern

Chilidonias leucapterus

Least Concern

Burung sepatu jengger

Comb crested jacana

Irediparra gallinacea

Least Concern

Pacific golden plover

Pluvialis fulva

Least Concern

Common sandpiper

Acitis hypoleucos

Least Concern

Wood sandpiper

Tringia glareola

Least Concern

Red necked phalarope

Phalaropus lobatus

Least Concern

4
5
6
7

Cerek kernyut
Trinil pantai
Trinil semak
Kaki rumbai kecil

West Sulawesi wetland habitats are a suitable habitat for shore birds,
including:

Mangrove and mud flats along Mamuju beach. Mangroves have


particularly rich associated fauna of crustaceans and molluscs which are
preferred habitats for migratory as well as resident waterbirds.

Lake and Brackish water Fishponds (tambak). The Lake and fishponds
are not known to support large numbers of shorebirds, but may do so
during the dry season, when large areas of mud are exposed.

Holmes and Phillips, 1999 have identified of sea birds in western


Sulawesi, as shown in Table 3-3.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-26

Table 3-3

Sea Birds in Western Sulawesi (Holmes and Phillips, 1999)

No

Local Name

International Name

Scientific Name

Stat
us

Cikalang kecil

Lesser frigatebird

Fregata ariel

LC

Pecuk padi belang

Little pied cormorant

Phalacrocorax melanoleucos

LC

Pecuk padi hitam

Little black cormorant

Phalacrocorax sulcirostris

LC

Pecuk ular asia

Oriental darter

Anhinga melanogaster

NT

Angsa batu coklat

Brown booby

Sula leucogaster

LC

Cangak merah

Purple Heron

Ardea purpurea

LC

Cangak laut

Great-billed Heron

Ardea sumatrana

LC

Kuntul kerbau

Cattle egret

Bubulcus ibis

LC

Blekok sawah

Javan pond heron

Ardeola speciosa

LC

10

Kuntul besar

Great egret

Casmerodius albus

LC

11

Kuntul perak

Intermediate egret

Egreta intermedia/
Mesophoyx intermedia

LC

12

Kuntul kecil

Little egret

Egreta garzetta

LC

13

Kuntul belang

Pied heron

Egreta picata/Ardea picata

LC

14

Kokokan laut

Striated heron

Butorides striatus

NT

15

Kowak malam merah

Rufous night heron

Nycticorax caledonicus

LC

16

Bambangan merah

Cinnamon bittern

Ixobrychus cinnamomeus

LC

17

Bambangan kuning

Yellow bittern

Ixobrychus sinensis

LC

18

Bambangan hitam

Black bittern

Ixobrychus flavicollis

LC

19

Bangau sandang lawe

Wolly-necked stork

Ciconia episcopus

LC

20

Bangau bluwok

Milky stork

Mycteria cinerea

VU

21

Ibis rokoroko

Glossy ibis

Plegadis falcinellus

LC

22

Elang tiram

Osprey

Pandion haliaetus

LC

23

Elang laut perut putih

White bellied sea eagle

Haliaeetus leucogaster

LC

24

Elang paria

Black kite

Milvus migrans

LC

25

Itik benjut

Sunda teal

Anas gibberirfons

LC

26

Itik gunung

Pacific black duck

Anas superciliosa

LC

27

Maleo

Maleo

Macrocephalon maleo

EN

28

Wili-wili besar

Beach thick knee

Esacus magnirostis/Esacus
giganteus

NT

29

Dara laut batu

Bridled Tern

Sterna anaethetus

LC

30

Dara laut jambul besar

Great crested tern

Sterna bergii

LC

31

Dara laut benggala

Lesser crested tern

Sterna bengalensis

LC

32

Dara laut tengkuk


hitam

Black napped tern

Sterna sumatrana

LC

33

Dara laut kecil

Little tern

Sterna albifrons

LC

Notes:
EX
CR
VU
LC
NE

Extinct
Critically Endangered
Vulnerable
Least Concern
Not evaluated

EW
EN
NT
DD

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

Extinct in the Wild


Endangered
Near Threatened
Data Deficient

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-27

3.2.11

Coastal habitats
Coastal areas are the border between marine and terrestrial ecosystems. In a
coastal forests ecosystem, plants are clustered and formed specific units
according to their habitat. A unit of vegetation in a specific habitat is called
formation. Each formation is named according to the most dominant plant
species.
In the project zone of influence there are two types of forest found along the
coastal zone of Sulawesi Barat, namely coastal forest and mangrove. The
coastal zone is backed by a wide distribution of rainforest which is outside
the project area and zone of influence and so is not discussed here.

3.2.12

Mangrove Forest
The mangrove ecosystem structure found in West Sulawesi displays a
comprehensive growth of vegetation on the seedlings, saplings, and trees
overall (Figure 3-11).
Regeneration and sustainability of the mangroves is dependent on low levels
of disturbance or disruption of the ecosystem and areas of the mangrove have
species that are categorized as low at all levels of vegetation growth. These
are dominated by Bruguiera, Rhizophora apiculata and Rhizophora mucronata. In
addition to these species, Avicennia alba, Ceriops tagal, Casuarina equisetifolia,
Sonneratia caseolaris, Avicennia marina, and Lumnitzera racemosa are present.
Mangroves form an important habitat for a number of species, supporting
spawning grounds for fish and other marine species, providing feeding areas
for birds, reptiles, invertebrates and large mammals such as primates due to
the availability of nutrients and food throughout the year.
The species of birds found in mangrove forests are listed in Table 3-4.
Table 3-4 Birds Found in Mangrove Forrest of Western Sulawesi
No

Local Name

International Name

Scientific Name

Status

Cangak merah

Purple Heron

Ardea purpurea

LC

Kuntul kecil

Heron Reef

Egretta sacra

LC

Kuntul kerbau

Cattle Egret

Bubulcus ibis

LC

Cekakak china

Black-capped Kingfisher

Halcyon pileata

LC

Cekakak sungai

Collared Kingfisher

Todirhamphus chloris

LC

Raja udang kalung biru

Blue-banded Kingfisher

Alcedo euryzona

VU

Trinil bedaran

Terek Sandpiper

Tringa cinereus

LC

Elang bondol

Brahminy Kite

Haliastur Indus

LC

Blekok sawah

Javan pond heron

Ardeola speciosa

LC

10

Kacer

Oriental Magpie Robin

Copsychus saularis

LC

11

Kacamata laut

Lemon-bellied White-eye

Zosterops chloris

LC

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-28

No

Local Name

International Name

Scientific Name

Status

12

Cinenen merah

Rufous-tailed Tailorbird

Orthotomus sericeus

LC

13

Cabai polos

Plain Flowerpecker

Dicaeum concolor

LC

14

Bambangan coklat

Schrenck's Bittern

Ixobrychus eurhythmus

NR

15

Cinenen kelabu

Ashy Tailorbird

Orthotomus ruficeps

LC

16

Kekep Babi

White-breasted
Woodswallow

Artamus leucorynchus

LC

17

Itik benjut

Sunda Teal

Anas gibberifrons

LC

Figure 3-11

3.2.13

Typical Narrow Band of Mangrove Ecosystem Found in Mamuju due


to Steep Topography at Coast of Mamuju

Coastal Forest
Coastal forest consists of the Pes-Caprae and the Baringtonia formation.

3.2.13.1 Pescaprae Formation


In the Pescaprae formation, the dominant plants are Ipomoea pres-caprae,
Vigna, Spinifex littoreus (grass wind), Canavalia maritime, Euphorbia atoto,
Pandanus tectorius (pandanus), Crinum asiaticum (daffodils) and Scaevola
frutescens (babakoan). The Pescaprae formation is evenly distributed around
the coast of Mamuju (Figure 3-12).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-29

Figure 3-12

Pescaprae Formation around Coast of Mamuju

3.2.13.2 Baringtonia Formation


The dominant vegetation in this formation is the Baringtonia tree. Other
plants characterizing the habitat include Callophylum inophylum (nyamplung),
Erythrina, Hernandia, Hibiscus tiliaceus (sea hibiscus), Terminalia cattapa
(ketapang) (Figure 3-13).

Figure 3-13

Baringtonia Formation of Mamuju

3.2.13.3 Important, Rare, Endemic or Endangered Species (Flora and Fauna) both Onshore
and Offshore
Sulawesi Island is a very specific island; therefore the discussion of flora and
fauna can not be limited to West Sulawesi but to cover the entire Sulawesi
Island. There are 165 species of endemic mammals in Indonesia, almost half
of them (46%) are found in Sulawesi. Out of 127 species of mammal found in
Sulawesi, 79 species (62%) are endemic. On mainland Sulawesi there are 233
species of birds, 84 of them are endemic to Sulawesi. This number accounts
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-30

for more than one third of the 256 endemic bird species in Indonesia.
Sulawesi is inhabited by as many as 104 species of reptile and nearly 29 are
endemic species, which means, out of the 150 recorded endemic reptiles in
Indonesia, 20% are found on the island of Sulawesi.
West Sulawesi Province has more than 670,000 ha of protection forest
(protected forest administered by the Province) and about ten forest
concessions companies operates in the region totalling more than 430,000 ha
(including one adjacent concession in neighbouring Sulawesi Tengah).
Some endemic animals found in West Sulawesi are high land anoa, low land
anoa, deer, maleo bird, and Sulawesi black monkey. According to Sujatnika
(1995) some endemic birds exist are 'elang alap kecil' (Accipter nanus), 'maleo
senkawor' (Macrocephalon maleo), 'mandar dengkur' (Aramidopsis plateni),
'kareo Sulawesi' (Amauromis isabellina), 'pergam tutu' (Ducula forsteni),
'delimukan Sulawesi' (Gallicomba tristigmata), 'serindit paruh merah' (Loriculus
exllis), 'pungguk oker' (Ninox ochracea), 'cekakak hutan tungging hijau'
(Actenoides monachus), 'cirik-cirik pasa' (Meropogon forsteni), 'kepodang-sungu
biru' (Coracina temminckii), 'sikatan leher merah' (Ficedula rufigula), 'kacamata
perut pucat' (Zosterops consobrinorum), and 'raja perling Sulawesi' (Basilornis
celebensis).
3.2.13.4 Conservation Areas in the Project Zone of Influence
In the Government Regulation No. 26 of 2008 regarding the National Spatial
Plan in Annex VIII, there is only one area listed as Wildlife Refuge, namely
Suaka Margasatwa Mampie Lampoko (Lampoko Mampie Reservation).
Lampoko Mampie Reservation is a wildlife reserve park located on the island
of Sulawesi, with an area of nearly 2.000 ha. This reservation is located
precisely in the western part of South Sulawesi Province, in Polewali Mamasa
Regency (Figure 3-14).
The condition of the Wildlife Park consists of wetland and marshy areas
which include 300 ha of secondary forest, swamp forest and mangrove areas.
This wildlife reserve is a very important area for plants and animals
especially for Mandar Sulawesi birds or Ballidae or Celebes Rails (Aramidopsis
plateni) and Ibis hitam (Plegadis fascinelus) which are endemic, as well as being
a refuge for migratory birds.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-31

Figure 3-14

Location of Mampie Lampoko Reservation

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-32

3.2.14

Social Characterization
The location of the proposed exploration drilling program is in the offshore
area and far from any settlements. However, an understanding of the social
characteristics in the area is important from a stakeholder standpoint and
includes social composition and structure, economic activity such as marine
users as well as coastal communities and uses in Karampuang Island (Figure
3-15) and along the shoreline of Mamuju Regency (Malunda, Deking,
Tapalang and Tapandulu) that may be affected by a potential accidental
scenario.
Karampuang Island and Malunda, Deking, Tapalang and
Tapandulu in the Mamuju Regency are within the territory area of the
Province of West Sulawesi. Due to the lack of social data for these areas,
representative social baseline data is based on available data for the Mamuju
Regency.

Figure 3-15

Karampuang Island (A) and Main Activities: (B) Inhabitant/Village,


(C) Recreational Resort run by local government, and (D) Floating net
aquaculture

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-33

3.2.14.1 Population and Settlement


From 2000 to 2007 the population of the Mamuju Regency grew by
34.02 %from 223,415 to 299,285, as shown in Table 3-5. The annual
population growth fluctuated between 2.88 to 5.87% over this period,
representing a mean growth of 4.3%. This is probably attributable to
migration.
Table 3-5

Population Development and Growth of Mamuju Regency, 2000-2007

Year

Population
(person)

Incremental
(person)

Growth
(%)

2000

223.415

2001

229.852

6.437

2.88

2002

241.664

11.812

5.14

2003

249.475

7.811

3.23

2004

264.123

14.648

5.87

2005

273,076

8,953

3.39

2006

284,026

10,950

4.01

2007

299.285

15,259

5.37

Average

4.27

Source: Spatial Planning of Mamuju Regency, 2006

3.2.14.2 Population Distribution


The population of Mamuju Regency is distributed in 15 sub-districts, with
population densities dependent on economic pull factors. Population density
changes in 2007 compared to 2006 data for every sub-district were relatively
small.
The population density of Mamuju Regency increased from
33.0 people/km2 in 2006 to 37.3 people/km2 in 2007 and it is categorized as
low. The three most populated sub-districts in the Mamuju Regency are
Mamuju, Simboro-Kep and Tobadak, where the population density in 2007
was 257.94, 192.97 and 185.33 people/km2, respectively, as shown in Table
3-6. No data are available for the period since 2007. Mamuju is the capital
city of West Sulawesi Province and provides greater economic opportunities
as a result.
Table 3-6

Population Distribution and Density of Mamuju Regency 2004 and 2007

Sub-District
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.

Area (km2)

Tapalang
Tapalang Barat
Mamuju
Simboro-Kep
Kalukku
Papalang
Sampaga
Tommo

504,11
127,14
160,24
100,69
461,99
160,43
95,94
588,28

Population
(person)
2004
2007
15,253
15,500
7,718
9,415
35,157
41,332
20,235
19,430
34,354
42,500
18,056
18,453
11,914
13,054
15,104
19,249

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

Population Density
(person/ km2)
2004
2007
30.3
30.7
60.7
74.1
219.4
257.9
201.0
193.0
74.4
92.0
112.5
115.0
124.2
136.1
25.7
32.7

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-34

Sub-District

Area (km2)

9. Kalumpung
10. Bonehau
11. Budong-Budong
12. Pangale
13. Topoyo
14. Karossa
15. Tobadak
TOTAL

1,778, 21
950,76
1,140,43
232,52
543,88
1,069,31
100,13
8,014,06

Population
(person)
2004
2007
9,921
12,375
6,927
9,398
19,088
23,306
12,464
12,522
19,910
22,166
18,577
22,028
19,443
18,557
264,123
299,285

Population Density
(person/ km2)
2004
2007
5.6
7.0
7.3
9.9
16.7
20.4
53.6
53.9
36.6
40.8
17.4
20.6
194.2
185.3
33.0
37.3

3.2.14.3 Gender Ratio


The gender ratio illustrates the proportion of men to women, expressed by
the number of males per 100 women. The population composition of
Mamuju Regency based on gender in comparison to the sub-districts for the
years 2006 and 2007 is shown in Table 3-7.
According to available data, the overall gender ratio of the Mamuju Regency
in 2006-2007 stabilized at 105, which means that the number of men is slightly
higher than women, with the exception the of Sampaga Sub-district where
the number of women is higher.
Table 3-7
Sub District
Tapalang

Gender Ratio of Mamuju Regency, 2006 and 2007


2006
Gender
Male
Female
7.374
7.362

Total
Population
14.736

Gender
Ratio
100,16

Gender
Male
Female
7,882
7,618

2007
Total
Population
15,500

Gender
Ratio
103,47
110,86

Tapalang
Barat
Mamuju

3.513

3.479

6.992

100,98

4,950

4,465

9,415

19.060

18.791

37.851

106,88

20,538

20,794

41,332

98,77

Simboro Kep.

10.066

9.418

19.484

101,43

9,903

9,527

19,430

103,95

Kalukku

20.514

19.335

39.849

106,10

21,205

21,295

42,500

99,58

Papalang

9.921

10.128

20.049

97,96

9,454

8,999

18,453

105,06

Sampaga

6.454

6.689

13.143

96,49

6,393

6,661

13,054

95,98

Tommo

9.042

7.839

16.881

115,35

10,319

8,930

19,249

115,55

Kalumpang

6.505

6.284

12.789

103,51

6,303

6,072

12,375

103,80

Bonehau

4.934

3.822

8.756

129,09

4,970

4,428

9,398

112,24

BudongBudong
Pangale

9.761

9.839

19.600

99,21

12,176

11,130

23,306

109,40

6.782

5.960

12.742

113,79

6,592

5,930

12,522

111,16

Topoyo

11.065

10.692

21.757

103,49

11,428

10,738

22,166

106,43

Karossa

10.279

9.315

19.594

110,35

11,694

10,334

22,028

113,16

Tobadak

10.833

8.970

19.803

120,77

9,829

8,728

18,557

112,16

TOTAL

146.103

137.923

284.026

105,93

153,636

145,649

299,285

105,48

Source: BPS - Statistics of Mamuju Regency, 2008. Calculated

3.2.14.4 Dependency Ratio


The population composition based on age and gender for the year 2004 and
2006 is shown in Table 3-8. The Department of Domestic Affairs of the
Republic of Indonesia stated that a population is referred to as young if the
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-35

population in the 014 years old category accounts for more than 30% of the
total population. Referring to this categorization, the population structure of
the Mamuju Regency overall is categorized as relatively young (35% of the
population is less than 15 years old), which contributes to a high dependency
ratio.
Table 3-8
Age
Group
04
59
10 14
15 19
20 24
25 29
30 34
35 39
40 44
45 49
50 54
55 59
60 64
65 +
Total

Population Composition Based on Age and Gender in Mamuju


Regency, 2004 and 2006

2004
Gender
Total
Male
Female
18.467
17.187
35.654
18.382
18.301
36.683
18.430
14.232
32.662
11.466
13.057
24.523
9.192
10.029
19.221
10.333
12.516
22.849
11.277
10.820
22.097
10.448
9.668
20.114
8.387
6.890
15.277
6.181
5.098
11.279
5.079
3.576
8.655
3.060
2.190
5.250
2.586
1.935
4.521
3.361
1.977
5.338
136,647 127,476
264,123

2006
%
13.50
13.89
12.37
9.28
7.28
8.65
8.37
7.62
5.78
4.27
3.28
1.98
1.71
2.02
100.00

Gender
Male
Female
16,860
14,689
17,737
16,537
19,534
16,633
12,404
14,110
11,454
11,696
11,980
13,448
11,104
10,592
12,726
10,578
6,955
9,047
8,006
5,848
5,830
5,434
3,273
3,807
3,506
2,152
4,734
3,352
146,103 137,923

Total

31,549
34,274
36,167
26,514
23,150
25,428
21,696
23,304
16,002
13,854
11,264
7,080
5,658
8,086
284,026

11.11
12.07
12.73
9.34
8.15
8.95
7.64
8.20
5.63
4.88
3.97
2.49
1.99
2.85
100.00

Source: BPS - Statistics of Mamuju Regency, 2008. Calculated

60 64

Age Group

50 54
40 44
30 34
20 24

Female
Male

10 14
04
-20,000 -15,000 -10,000 -5,000

5,000 10,000 15,000 20,000

Population
04

59

10 14 15 19 20 24 25 29 30 34 35 39 40 44 45 49 50 54 55 59 60 64

65 +

Female -17,187 -18,301 -14,232 -13,057 -10,029 -12,516 -10,820 -9,668 -6,890 -5,098 -3,576 -2,190 -1,935 -1,977
Male

18,467 18,382 18,430 11,466

9,192

10,333 11,277 10,448 8,387

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

6,181

5,079

3,060

2,586

3,361

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-36

60 64
Female
Male

Age Group

50 54
40 44
30 34
20 24
10 14
04
-20,000-15,000-10,000 -5,000

5,000 10,000 15,000 20,000

Population ( 2006 )
04

59

10 14 15 19 20 24 25 29 30 34 35 39 40 44 45 49 50 54 55 59 60 64

65 +

Female -14,689 -16,537 -16,633 -14,110 -11,696 -13,448 -10,592 -10,578 -9,047 -5,848 -5,434 -3,807 -2,152 -3,352
Male

16,860 17,737 19,534 12,404 11,454 11,980 11,104 12,726 6,955

8,006

5,830

3,273

3,506

4,734

The dependency ratio (DR) is the ratio of the population of non-working age
(under 15 years and older than 65 years) compared to the number of people
available for the workforce (15 to 64 years). The dependency ratio is
calculated using the following formula:
DR =

DR
P0-14
P15-64
P65+

P014 + P65+
100
P1564

: Dependency Ratio
: Population in the 0 14 years
: Population in the 15 64 years
: Population older than 65 years

A high number means a high dependency (i.e. predominance of a non


working population). The dependency ratios for 2004 and 2006 were 71.75
and 63.28 respectively which are relatively high compared to Indonesias
average dependency ratio of 54 based on the 2000 census. However Mamuju
Regency ratio during 2004 to 2006 was decreased from 71.75 in 2004 to 63.28
in 2006 representing a relative increase number of the population of working
age. The population pyramid only illustrates the population age structure
and does not reflect the availability of work opportunities.
3.2.15

Custom and Religion


The religions present in the Mamuju Regency are Moslem, Christianity,
Hinduism and Buddhism; consistent with those in Indonesia in general. The
majority of people are Moslem, representing 227,228 people or 86.03%, while

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-37

Buddhism forms the minority, with 181 people or 0.07%. The religious
composition of the community is provided in Table 3-9.
Table 3-9
No
1
2
3
4
5

Population Structure Based on Religion in Mamuju Regency


Religion
Moslem
Rome Catholic
Protestant Christian
Hinduism
Buddhism
Total

Population(Person)
227,228
3.353
26.193
7.168
181
264,123

(%)
86.03
1.27
9.92
2.71
0.07
100.00

Source: Spatial Plan of Mamuju Regency, 2006

3.2.16

Education and Literacy


A number of educational programs designed by government have provided a
greater access to education for the local population. The literacy level for the
segment of the population aged above 15 years old in the Mamuju Regency is
85.7% (SUSENAS 2005). Over 70% of education facilities available in the
districts are Elementary Schools/Elementary Islamic Schools, totaling 375
(Table 3-10). Approximately 70% of the population has had an education to
elementary level, while only 2% of the population is in higher education
Table 3-10
Level of Education

Number of Schools. Teachers and Students in Mamuju in 2007


Number of Schools
State Private
Total

Elementary School (SD)


357
Islamic Elementary School
1
Junior High School (SMP)
36
Islamic Junior High School
1
Senior High School (SMA)
11
Islamic Senior High School
1
Vocational High School
6
University

Total
Source: BPS Mamuju Regency 2008

1
16
17
26
8
13
9
6

358
17
53
27
19
14
15
6

Teachers
2,482
111
795
339
485
169
268
734

State

Students
Private

53,021
122
10,953
429
3,840
314
946

33
1,077
2,098
1,794
712
1,063
1,066
1,382

Total

Percent of
Students

53,054
1,199
13,051
2,223
4,552
1,377
2,012
1,382
78,850

67.3
1.5
16.5
2.8
5.8
1.7
2.5
1.8
100.0

At present, 13 colleges are available in West Sulawesi, comprising two


universities and 11 academies/colleges. The two universities are West
Sulawesi University located in Majene and Al Syariah University in Polewali
Mandar. The West Sulawesi University (Unisbar) was established in 2007
and started enrolling students in July of 2008. Unisbar, which secured
approval from the education minister in November 2007, is managed by
Yayasan Pendidikan Indonesia Sulawesi Barat/West Sulawesi Indonesian
Education Foundation (Yapisba). The colleges locations are concentrated in
three areas; six are in the capital city of Mamuju, four in Majene and one in
Polewali Mandar (Table 3-11).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-38

Table 3-11

Universities and Academies in West Sulawesi Province

Mamuju District

Majene District

Fatima Nursing Academy

University of West Sulawesi

Al Syariah University

Tomakaka College of Information


and Computer Management

Bina
Sehat
Midwife
Academy

Bina Generasi College of


Health
Studies

Muhammadiyah College of
Economics

Majene College of Health


Studies

Tanratupattanabali College of
Agriculture

Yapman Majene College of


Economics

Tanratupattanabali College
Social and Political Sciences

Darud Dawah Wal Irsyad


College
of
Teaching
and
Education Studies

of

Polewali Mandar District


Nusantara

Marendeng Majene College


of Health Studies

Source: BPS Mamuju Regency 2008

The declining number of people going to higher education has been


translated into an indicator for Participation in Education. Figure 3-16
illustrates, as level of education increased community participation level
decreased. This is largely attributable to the cost to attend higher level of
education. The ever increasing expense of attending junior and senior high
school diminishes the access of the poor to education.

Source: Regional Action Plan of PPDT for West Sulawesi, 2007


Notes:
1) SD/MI = Elementary School/Elementary Islamic School
2) SMP/MTS = Junior High School / Islamic Junior High School
3) SMA/MA = Senior High School / Islamic Senior High School

Figure 3-16

Participation of the education level

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-39

3.2.17

Public and Private Infrastructure


Basic community infrastructure includes transportation systems (roads,
airport, and seaport), telecommunication, market facilities, banking,
warehousing, fuel supply, electricity and clean water.

3.2.17.1 Transportation and Traffic


Transportation infrastructure (land, sea and air) in West Sulawesi is adequate
and supports intra-province flows of people and goods, input-output of
agricultural products, plantation and access to maritime activities (Table 3-12
and Table 3-13). However, the transportation infrastructure is basic and
needs to be improved to be able to support industries such as mining (as
among others coal and gold) and oil gas industries, West Sulawesi (Country
and Regional Profile Report, 2008).
Table 3-12
No.
1.

Transportation Facilities in West Sulawesi Province


Types of Transportation
Facility
Land

Sea

3.

Air

Description
Trans Sulawesi Roads
Main Provincial Road connecting regencies in
West Sulawesi
Regency bridges connecting subdistricts in West
Sulawesi
Ferry Port in Simboro Mamuju
Sea Port in Belang-Belang Bakengkeng Mamuju
Fish Port in Manakara Mamuju
Silopo Port in Polewali Mandar
Palippi Port in Majene
Pasang Kayu Port in Mamuju Utara
Specialized Port of CPO (Crude Palm Oil)
Tampa Padang Airport in Kalukku
Accommodates turbo propeller aircraft, 4 times a
week, route Mamuju - Makassar

Source: West Sulawesi PPDT Regional Action Plans, 2008-2009.

The following subsections provide further detail on transportation


infrastructure and traffic levels
Road Transportation
In 2007, the road coverage in the Mamuju Regency is 1,697.3 km, of this
approximately 221.50 km of road was under the State authority, 154 km
under province authority and 1,321.80 km under the regency authority. The
majority of roads are gravel surfaced, with a small proportion with asphalt.
The categorization road by type of surface and authority of control is shown
on Table 3-13.
The condition of the road infrastructure is poor overall. Of the total road
coverage in the Mamuju Regency reported only 50 % is in good condition,
while 20 % is moderate, 25 % damaged and 5 % badly damaged (Table 3-14).
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-40

Table 3-13

Road Length by Government Responsibility per Type of Surface in


Mamuju Regency, 2007 (in Km)

Type of Surface Road

Class of Road
State

Province

Regency

221.50

60.00

196.00

Gravel

94.00

703.10

Land

422.70

221.50

154.00

1,321.80

Asphalted

TOTAL

Source: - Public Works Agency Office. Mamuju Regency

Table 3-14

Road Condition by Government Responsibility per Conditions in


Mamuju Regency. 2007 (in Km)

Road Conditions
Good

State

Province

Regency

206.50

60.00

538.37

Moderate

15.00

94.00

209.61

Damaged

474.66

Badly Damaged

99.16

221.5

154.00

1,321.80

TOTAL

Source: - Public Works Agency Office. Mamuju Regency

Sea Transportation
Main shipping routes, all national level, are shown in Figure 3-17. No
international shipping are routing this area. In 2007, passenger traffic in the
Mamuju Regency consisted of 66,315 people with roughly equal numbers of
people embarking and disembarking vessels.
Port facilities and cargo handling capacity in West Sulawesi is limited and
include the Rakyat Palipi anchorage in Majene, Fery Simbono anchorage and
Belang-belang port in Mamuju. To support the fishing industry in West
Sulawesi, the government built three ports: Port Lantora, Polewali Mandar;
Port Banggae, Majene District and Port Landing Kasiwa, all are located in
Mamuju District. The Port Landing Kasiwa in Mamuju serves as the main
port (Pangkalan Pendaratan Ikan) supporting the fisheries product/fishing
catch industry.
Several harbors are situated in the islands around the West Sulawesi
Province, connecting these areas to Sulawesi, Borneo, and Java etc. The Ferry
Simboro anchorage in Mamuju services a route to Balikpapan (Borneo),
Rakyat Palippi anchorage in Majene, and Belang-Belang in Mamuju.
The volume of loaded and unloaded goods at the main harbors at Belangbelang at Mamuju in 2007 was 304,776 tons, consisting of 267,614 tons loaded
goods and 37,162 tons unloaded. No data are available for the other ports.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-41

Figure 3-17

Transportation lines

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-42

Air Transportation
In 2007, passengers from the Tampa Padang Airport were about 5,878 people,
where the number of departed passenger is 3,061 people, and the number of
arrived passenger is 2,817 people. The volume of unloaded baggage goods at
the Tampa Padang Airport in 2007 was about 15,271 kg; meanwhile the
volume of up loaded goods was 14,549 kg.
3.2.17.2 Telecommunication
The number of Telephone Lines Based on Customers Categories in Mamuju
Regency is presented in Table 3-15.
Table 3-15

Number of Telephone Lines Based on Customers Categories in


Mamuju Regency

Customers Category
Residence

Year
2002

1,282

1,371

83.80

15

15

15

0.92

Shopping Centre

79

81

84

5.13

102

105

110

6.72

Social Purposes

0.00

61

56

56

3.43

1,541

1,539

1,636

100.00

Public Telephone
TOTAL

(%)

2004

1,284

Hotel/Motel
Government & Private Company

2003

Source : Monography of Mamuju Regency, 2006

3.2.17.3 Commercial Infrastructure


The commercial infrastructure in the Mamuju Regency region is basic and
includes markets, shops, restaurants, hotels/motels and post offices (Table
3-16).
Table 3-16

Number of Facilities of Trading and Services in Mamuju Regency

No

Number of Facility
(Unit)

Facility

54

(%)

Market

Shop

1.14

Restaurant (Small)

84

47.73

Hotel/Motel

30

17.05

Pos Office

3.41

176

100.00

Total

30.67

Source : Spatial Planning of Mamuju Regency. 2007

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-43

3.2.18

Socio-Economics and Livelihood

3.2.18.1 Labor conditions


In the Mamuju Regency, the majority of the population is working in the
agricultural sector, followed by the trade sector (Table 3-17). The majority of
this labour is unskilled with only 29.7 % having an education to elementary
level (Figure 3-18). Minimum wages for all industries as a mean value is
provided in Table 3-18.
Table 3-17

Population Structure Based on Employment in Mamuju Regency

No

Main Occupacion

Number of
Person

Agricultural

Mining & Quarrying Industry,


Manufacturing, Electricity, Gas and Water,
and Construction

Trade, Transportation & Telecommunication.


Finance and Services
TOTAL

(%)

79,712

76.58

2,555

1.90

13,429

21.52

95,696

100.00

Source: Monography of Mamuju Regency. 2006

Source: Mamuju Regency in Figures 2008

Figure 3-18

Working Population based on Education Level in Mamuju Regency in


2007

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-44

Table 3-18

Minimum Wages in West Sulawesi Province, 2005 - 2009

Year

Per Day (IDR)

Per Month (IDR)

2005

20,400

510,000

2006

24,480

612,000

2007

26,800

670,000

2008

30,420

760,500

2009
36,376
Source : West Sulawesi in Figure 2007

909,400

Based on the Country and Regional Report extracted from West Sulawesi
Province in Figure 2007, the project location is surrounded by artisanal
fisheries consist of fishing capture activity and marine culture activity (see
page 3-55). The fishing activities are important as source of foods and as an
economically viable income. Most of the community depend their life on
fishing activity as fishermen, or fish collector. Agriculture (including fishery)
contributed the highest number of the workforce, about 55.91 percent,
followed by trade and services at 34.83 percent and industry or
manufacturing at 11.36 percent1.
3.2.18.2 Land use and Occupation
Commercial land uses in the Mamuju Regency includes paddy fields,
plantations, pasture and other farming. The status of land use categories for
the Mamuju Regency in 2006 is shown in Table 3-20.
Table 3-19
No
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14

Land Used of Mamuju Regency, 2006


Area
(Ha)
3,818,754
17,486,858
18,148,273
96,403,680
42,937,524
26,298,094
516,262,799
56,019,915
2,168,620
6,132,530
5,484,851
221,118
443,129
9,579,855
801,406,000

Land Use
Settlements/Kampung
Paddy Fields
Moor
Cultivated Fields
Plantation
Pasture
Dense Forest
Forest Type
Shrub
Fresh Water Ponds
River
Swamp
Barren Land
Areas for Other Uses
TOTAL

(%)
0.48
2.18
2.26
12.03
5.36
3.28
64.42
6.99
0.27
0.77
0.68
0.03
0.06
1.19
100.00

Source: Spatial Planning of Mamuju Regency,

(1) 1Country and Regional Country Report exact from West Sulawesi Province in Figure 2007

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-45

As shown in the above table, the predominant form of land cover is dense
forest (64.42%) followed by cultivated fields or farming (12.03%). Based on
forest maps, 34.7% of the forest coverage is designated as protection forests.
Production forests account for 7.8% of the total forest area, convertible
production forest 6.2 %, and limited production forest 31.5%, with 19% for
other uses (Table 3-20). The majority of the protection forests are located in
the eastern part of the regency far from the area of influence of the project.
Table 3-20

Spatial Distribution of Forest Function in Mamuju Regency, 2006

Type of Forest
Protection Forest
Production Forest
Conversion Production
Limited Production
Lake/Water
Areas for Other Uses
TOTAL

Area ( Ha )
257.543
57,781
46,452
234,182
3,685
143,389
743,032

Percent
34.7
7.8
6.2
31.5
0.5
19.3
100.0

Source: Country and Regional Profile Report, 2008 page III-10

3.2.18.3 Fishing
Species targeted
Fish species targeted in the area include pelagic, demersal and coral fish
species. These fish are either sold fresh or processed. The economically
important species are Skipjack tuna (Katsuwonus pelamis), Eastern little tuna
(Euthunnus affinis), big eye tuna (Thunus obesus), albacore (Thunnus alalungga),
yellow fine tuna (Thunnus albaceres), Cob (Auxis thazard), lacepede
(Scromberamorus commerson), Baramundi (Lates calcalifer), and groupers such
as honey comb groupers (Plectropoma leopardus), rabbit fish (Siganus gutatus),
and red snappers (Lutjanus frontalis), banded grunts (Therapon theraps), rabbit
fish (Siganus gutatus), grouper (Epinephelus tauvina), yellowtails (Caesio
Erythrogaster), (Stolephorus spp). Other catches include sardinella (Clupea spp)
and mackerel (Rastrelliger spp), Lola (Trochus spp), lobsters (Panulirus spp), sea
cucumbers, and other types of molluscs.
Based on data from Department of Fisheries and Marine of Mamuju in 2006,
the economically important species are shown in Table 3-21.
Table 3-21
No

Local and Scientific Names and Value of Mainly Fish Caught in 2006

Local/Common
name

English term

Production
(ton)

Total Value
(x Rp 1,000)

Epinephus sp

40

1,080,000

Scientific name

A. Type of Fish
1

Keraphu

Grouper

Cucut

Shark

Sphyma

25

315,000

970

3,395,000

Layang

Sardine

Decapterus
russelli

Teri

Anchovy

Stolephorus sp.

38

114,000

Tembang

Sardine

Sardinella

72

180,000

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-46

No

Local/Common
name

Scientific name

English term

Production
(ton)

Total Value
(x Rp 1,000)

58

580,000

36

288,000

1,935

5,805,000

63

315,000

59

531,000

fimbriata
6

Tenggiri papan

Mackerel sp

Tenggiri

Mackerel

Tongkol

Tuna

Scromberomorus
gutatus
Scorombemous
commersonii
Auxis thazard
Upeneus
sulphurues
Lutjanus
sanguineus

Biji Nangka

Goatfish

10

Bambangan

Snapper

11

Tuna

Tuna

Thunnus spp

1,398

15,378,000

Skipjack

Katsuwonus
pelamis

1,376

4,128,000

12

Cakalang

B. Other Sea Products


13

Kepiting

Crab

Scyla sp

40,000

14

Lobster

Lobster

Panulius sp

280,000

15

Kerang darah

Shells

Anadara granosa

15,000

16

Cumi-cumi

Squid

Loligo sp

90,000

17

Sotong

Cuttlefish

Sephia sp.

50,000

18

Teripang

Sea cucumber

Holothuria sp.

31

465,000

19

Rajungan

Crab

Potunus pelagicus

524,000

Sources: Department of Fishery and Marine, 2006

Fishing Activities at West Sulawesi


Sulawesi Barat has shoreline approximately 677 km in length from North to
South. There are 31 named islands and a sea area of approximately
20,342 km2. Fishing effort in the area consists of commercial and artisanal
fishing activity.
In 2007, the total tonnage of fish caught in West Sulawesi reached about
66,448.7 tons, an increase of 29.6 % compared to that of 2006. Most
production was dominated by small scale fisheries, as presented in Table 323.
Table 3-22

Number of Production in West Sulawesi

No

Item

Production

Year (in ton)


2006

2007

46,725.1

66,448.7

%
29.6

Sources: Marine and Fisheries Regencies Office, 2008

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-47

The fish capture production by regency is as follows:


Table 3-23

Commodity of high economic value in 2006 and 2007


Year (in ton)

North Mamuju

Majene

Polewali Utara

Mamuju

North Mamuju

Majene

Polewali Utara

2007

Mamuju

2006

Tuna

2,145

10.5

782

3,126

13,869

356

1,135

3,129

Skipjack

2,911

4.0

694

3,161

2,978

381

754

3,161

Tuna sp

3,314

790

3,374

3,497

300

923

3,374

Mackerel

3,0

3.0

51

124

21

55

55

124

Grouper

78,0

43

55

139

56

55

Snapper

101

8.9

224

223

84

21

133

223

Sea Cucumber

7.6

2.1

103

11

2,1

8.552

26.4

2,591

1,114

3,068

10,069

No

Type of fish

Total

10,067 20,693

Sources: Marine and Fisheries Regencies Officer, 2008

Fishing effort in West Sulawesi is dominated by small boats which of < 5


tonnes, many without engine or with small outboard motors (Table 3-26).
Fishing vessels may originate from Sulawesi or outside, e.g. Bala Balakang, is
the one fishing ground that brings fishermen from outside Sulawesi e.g
Pekalongan and Indramayu Central Java. The location of fishing areas is
shows in Figure 3-19 while numbers of fishing vessels are shown in Table
3-24.
Table 3-24

Numbers of fishing vessel by regencies in 2006 and 2007 (unit)


Year (in ton)

North Mamuju

Majene

Polewali Utara

Mamuju

North Mamuju

Majene

Polewali Utara

2007

Mamuju

2006

1,450

1,472

573

1,450

1,472

593

Out-boards motors

621

1,191

830

733

621

1,191

830

789

3
4

Boats motors
< 5 Gross tonnage (GT)

521

288

702

398

521

288

702

351

5 10 Gross tonnage (GT)

52

236

81

52

236

82

2,644

1,479

3,240

1,785

2,644

1,479

3,240

1,815

No

Categories

Non-powered motores

Total

Sources: Marine and Fisheries Regencies Officer, 2008

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-48

Fishing methods
There are various types of fishing activity in this area which are Purse Seine,
Hooks and lines, stake trap, bamboo fish pond, lift Net, spearing gear,
dredges and Lola (Trochus spp) fishing boat. The number of known fishing
units in West Sulawesi is provided in Table 3-25.
Table 3-25
No

Numbers and type of fishing gears in West Sulawesi (unit)


Name of fishing gears

Total (unit)

Mini purse seine

522

Beach seine

269

Drift gill net

2,778

Encicling gill net

319

Set Gill net

598

Boat lift sets

72

Fish trap with lamp

58

Fish trap

72

Drift line

58

10

Troil line

27

11

Hand line

2,406

12

Hook

2,457

13

Set Rip Line

1,871

14

Other Pole and Line

777

15

Other Pole and line

1,270

16

Fish pots

66

17

Shell Fish Collection

104

18

Sea Cucumber Collection

62

19

Fish Plummet

Sources: Marine and Fisheries Regencies Officer, 2008

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-49

Figure 3-19

Potential fishing areas

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-50

A summary of fishing activity by gear type for the Mamuju District is shown
in Table 3-27. Fishermen indicated that they fished throughout the year.
However, different types of fishing are used at different times of the year e.g.
June to October is the season for Purse Seine, and December to January is the
season for stake trap. On average, fishing activity occurs on 10 to 20 days per
month.
Some fishers also practice the use of rumpon or Fish Aggregation Devices
(FAD) set at the fishing grounds to catch the fish. Based on seismic data in
2008, approximately 81 rumpon were identified in the Karama Block and its
vicinity (Figure 3-20 and Table 3-26). Most of the rumpon are owned by
fishermen originally from Mamuju, Kaluku, Pasang Kayu, and Baras.
Rumpon in Karama Block and its vicinity are located whithin 6 to 40 miles
from shoreline. The main aqua culture were identified as extending
approximately 2-10 meter from the shore lines and distributed 3-8 meters
depth.
Table 3-26

Category and Numbers of FAD in Karama Block, 2008

No

FAD Category

Numbers

1
2

Inside Karama Block


Outside Karama Block
Total

35
46
81

Sources: Environmental Management and Monitoring Effort Document Offshore 3D Seismic Survey in
Kuma and Karama Blocks, Makasar Strait, 2008

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-51

Table 3-27

Summary of Fishing Activities in Mamuju District


Type of Fishing Gear (Activity)

Parameter

Approximate number
of fishermen
Fishing time

Fishing frequency
(trip/month)
characterization of
vessels (dimension of
the boat in meters)
Number of personnel
per boat
Species captured

Estimate of catches
(kg)

Surrounding nets
(Purse Seine)

Hooks and
lines

Seine nets (stake


trap)

Not defined

Not defined

Not defined

One day fishing


(carried out at
night)
22

One day
fishing
20

( 12 x 2.5 x 1.5 )

14

Skipjack tuna
(Katsuwonus
pelamis) and
Eastern little tuna
(Euthunnus affinis)

Groupers
(Epinephelus
tauvina),
honey comb
groupers
(Plectropoma
leopardus),
rabbit fish
(Siganus
gutatus), and
red
snappers
(Lutjanus
frontalis)

banded grunts
(Therapon
theraps), rabbit
fish (Siganus
gutatus),
groupers
(Epinephelus
tauvina), squid
(Illex
argentinus) and
others

300 -2,000

1-4 fish

1-4 or 1-10
bundles

4 trip/week

Traps
(bamboo fish
pond)

Failing gear
(Lift Net)

Not defined

Not defined

2 to 3 days

One day
fishing

10

20

Grappling
and wounding
gears
(Spearing
gear)
Not defined

Dredges

Not defined

*Lola (Trochus
spp) fishing
boat)
Not defined
3 month

10 /month

15
Small boat
(Katinting)

(15 x 1.5 x 1.5)


m
4-7

groupers
(Epinephelus
tauvina),
honey comb
groupers
(Plectropoma
leopardus),
rabbit fish
(Siganus
gutatus), red
snappers
(Lutjanus
frontalis), and
yellowtails
(Caesio
Erythrogaster)

anchovies
(Stolephorus
spp), Beside
anchovies,
other catches
include
sardinella
(Clupea spp)
and
mackerel
(Rastrelliger
spp)

25-50

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

groupers
(Epinephelus
tauvina),
honey comb
groupers
(Plectropoma
leopardus,
rabbit fish
(Siganus
gutatus), and
red snappers
(Lutjanus
frontalis)

groupers
(Epinephelus
tauvina),
rabbit fish
(Siganus
gutatus), and
other coral
reef fish

Lola (Trochus
spp), lobsters
(Panulirus
spp), sea
cucumbers,
and
other types of
mollusks

2-3 quintals

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-52

Type of Fishing Gear (Activity)


Parameter

Surrounding nets
(Purse Seine)

Hooks and
lines

Catches value
(Rp/kg)

3,000

200,000

Operational cost
(Rp./trip)
Fishing Season (peak
season)
Main fishing areas

400,000

60,000 80,000

June to October

The rumpon
Fishery
Aggregating
Device (FAD)
location (6-40
miles from shore)

1-2 miles (10


40 depth)

Fishing Port /market


sale

Port Lantora
(polewali
Mandar), Port
Banggae (Majene),
Port Landing
Kasiwa (Mamuju)

Seine nets (stake


trap)

Traps
(bamboo fish
pond)

30,000 80,000
or
15,000/bundles

December to
January
2 to 4 meter
depth

Failing gear
(Lift Net)

Grappling
and wounding
gears
(Spearing
gear)

Dredges

10,000

4 to 60 meters
depth (0.5 to 1
hours)

*Lola (Trochus
spp) fishing
boat)
50,000

100 1,000
meter from
shoreline (40
meters)

2-10 meters
depth

Dried and
send it to
Food factories.
Belang-belang
port

Sold and
personal
consumption

3 to 8 meters
depth

Kalimantan sea
waters
(panjang
Islands and
Laut Tanjung),
Karampuang
Island

Local market, inter


regional market in
Balikpapan
Sources: Regional Country Report, 2008

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-53

Figure 3-20 Rumpon location

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-54

3.2.18.4 Marine Aquaculture


The potential area for marine aquaculture in West Sulawesi is about
150,125 ha spreading into 4 coastal regencies located along Makasar strait,
comprising Mamuju, Majene, Polewali Mandar and North Mamuju. The
potential area for seaweed aquaculture is about 20,300 ha. Up to 2008, about
755 ha have been exploited; however, fisheries using floating net cover an
area of about 38,600 ha. There are around 19,159 ha still remaining as
potential area for marine aquaculture. Data of brackish water pond are not
available.
Seaweed cultivation occurs in the Mamuju Regency. The seaweed species
cultivated in this area is Euchema cononii . The potential area of seaweed in
Mamuju Regency is about 1,595 ha. The number of fishery households is
about 365, with total production reaching 750 ton/year.
The main centers of seaweed cultivation are located in Mamuju, Tadui,
Bamboo, and Karampuang villages (Mamuju and Babanga, Siyonyoi, and
Belang-Belang villages (Kaluku District) (Table 3-28).
Table 3-28

Potential areas of seaweed, production and numbers of households

No

District

Potential
Area (ha)

Seaweed
operation
units

Production
(tonnes)

Fisheries
Household

Mamuju

685

150

225

113

Kaluku

300

200

300

150

Papalang

50

50

75

37

Sources: Department of Fisheries and Marine, 2008

Seaweed cultivation takes place at a distance of 100 m from the shore and a
water depth of 1-3 m. Seedlings clusters approximately 60 grams in weight
are tied by a rope at the location and placed in 25 cm intervals. The area of
seaweed cultivation in relation to the Karama Block is presented in Figure 321.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-55

Figure 3-21 Seaweed cultivation area

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-56

3.2.18.5 Tourist activities


Maritime tourism in West Sulawesi is focused on five popular beaches:
Karampuang, Bakengkeng white sand, Datok Pangale, Gusung Toraja Island,
Palipis and Labuang beaches. Two of these five beaches, Karampuang and
Bakengkeng are located in the Mamuju Regency in the West Sulawesi
Province. Tourist activities include diving and boat tours and sailing in
traditional outriggers of various sizes; namely Sandeq the biggest, soppesoppe the medium and lepa-lepa the smallest. The main dive sites are
outwith the Karama Block.
3.2.19

Health

3.2.19.1 Life Expectancy and General Health Conditions


Life expectancy (LE) in the region varies among provinces. Over the period
2000 to 2005 the lowest was in Nusa Tenggara Barat with 60.9 years and the
highest was in Yogyakarta with 73.0 years. Life Expectancy in Sulawesi Barat
was not reported, but can be predicted using the Sulawesi Selatan Province
LE, which is 66.3 years and projected to be 70.9 years in 2010 2015.
3.2.19.2 Health Trends
The data of Mamuju Regency for the years 2005 - 2007 are provided in Table
3-29. The accuracy of health data is dependent upon a number of factors, not
least the availability of medical facilities/resources, reporting and accuracy of
medical diagnosis. However, such data can provide an indication of the main
issues in the community. The occurrence of diarrhea including dysentery and
suspected cholera are noteworthy because of their epidemic nature and link
to poor sanitation conditions.
Similarly, infant mortality rates (IMR) are commonly included as a part of
standard of living evaluations as an indicator of level of health or development,
and as a component of the physical quality of life index. The standard
definition of IMR is the number of deaths that occur in the first year of life for
1000 live births. Table 3-30 provides live birth data but this is only available
for births at hospitals and health centers in the region and does not include
data for infants under 1 year old. The IMR of 19 per 1000 live births is
calculated from the data for 2007. Indonesia has an IMR of 26.6 (UN, 2006).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-57

Table 3-29

Number of Patient and Death by Kind of Disease In Mamuju Regency,


2005-2007
2005

Disease

Patient

Dengue

2006
Death

Cholera

Patient
2

2007
Death

Patient
-

Death
2

3 595

1 560

14 963

Thypus

80

998

2 398

Rabies

24

90

Diarrhea

Tuberculosis (TB C)

246

260

87

20

Tetanus

Leprosy

37

40

34

Feverish

307

198

Diphtheria
Venereal

17

227

32

Meningitis

Encephalitis

Source: Health Service of Mamuju Regency

Table 3-30

Number of live births per District in Mamuju Regency, 2005-2007


2005

Sub-District
Tapalang
Tapalang Barat

Life
Birth

2006
Life
Birth

Died

350

207

2007
Died

Life Birth

2 (0.97)

145

Died
4 (2.76)

90

82

1 (1.22)

151

7 (4.64)

Mamuju

339

3 (0.88)

747

11 (1.47)

751

10 (1.33)

Simboro Kep

382

367

8 (2.18)

408

5 (1.23)

Kalukku

290

569

653

1 (0.15)

Papalang

201

274

4 (1.46)

316

12 (3.80)

Sampaga

411

3 (0.73)

217

1 (0.46)

203

6 (2.96)

Tommo

140

3 (2.14)

220

1 (0.45)

281

3 (1.07)

Kalumpang

109

138

2 (1.45)

226

6 (2.65)

Bonehau

168

1 (0.60)

99

3 (3.03)

140

2 (1.43)

Budong-Budong

171

301

5 (1.66)

276

8 (2.90)

Pangale

277

3 (1.08)

164

1 (0.61)

142

3 (2.11)

Topoyo

165

234

4 (1.71)

230

5 (2.17)

Karossa

154

134

5 (3.73)

302

10 (3.31)

Tobadak

182

1 (0.55)

330

5 (1.52)

306

7 (2.29)

3,429

14 (0.41)

4,083

53 (1.30)

4,530

89 (1.96)

TOTAL

Source: Health Service of Mamuju Regency

3.2.19.3 Health Facilities


The 2007 data indicate that health facilities in Mamuju Regency have
improved since 2005. The health facilities in the sub-districts area consist of
government funded village health centers and a new district health center.
According to data from the Health Service of Mamuju Regency, the number
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-58

of health facilities and staff in the villages are tabulated in (Table 3-31 and
Table 3-32):
Table 3-31
Sub-District

Number of Health Facilities per District in Mamuju Regency, 2007


General Hospital
State

Private

Public
Health
Center

Public
Health
Sub
Center

Medical
Clinic

Pharmacy
Storage

Private
Medical
Doctor

Village
Medical
Unit

Tapalang

Tapalang Barat

Mamuju

17

Simboro Kep

Kalukku

Papalang

Sampaga

Tommo

Kalumpang

Bonehau

Budong-Budong

Pangale

Topoyo

12

Karossa

10

Tobadak

TOTAL - 2007

23

99

42

50

- 2006

18

91

29

- 2005

17

86

29

Source: Health Service of Mamuju Regency

As reported in 2007, there are 216 health facilities in Mamuju Regency,


consisting of one Hospital, 23 of Puskesmas, 99 Ministrant Puskesmas, 1
pharmacy, 42 private clinic, and 50 Poskesdes (Table 3-32). Those facilities
are still inadequate compared to the number of population to serve and the
sub-province broad area which still remote and not entirely accessible.
Table 3-32

Sub-District
Tapalang
Tapalang Barat
Mamuju
Simboro dan Kep.
Kalukku
Papalang
Sampaga
Tommo
Kalumpang
Bonehau
Budong-Budong
Pangale
Topoyo
Karossa
Tobadak
TOTAL - 2007

Number of Paramedic by Kinds of Paramedic per Sub-District in


Mamuju Regency, 2007
Doctor
Medical
Doctor
3
5
2
2
1
1
3
2
19

Dentist
1
1
2
2
2

Specialis
Doctor
-

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

Nurse

Midwife

Baby
soothayer

7
8
24
7
19
9
10
15
7
10
13
9
22
12
6
178

3
4
7
5
7
1
2
4
1
4
4
2
4
1
49

19
12
32
14
53
21
13
27
20
14
16
13
24
30
16
324

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-59

Doctor
Medical
Specialis
Dentist
Doctor
Doctor
- 2006
43
9
- 2005
20
3
Source: Office of Religion Department of Mamuju Regency
Sub-District

3.2.20

Nurse

Midwife

Baby
soothayer

126
126

67
28

282
462

Stakeholder Identification and Engagement


Stakeholders are persons or groups who are directly or indirectly affected by
a project, as well as those who may have interests in a project and/or the
ability to influence its outcome, either positively or negatively. Stakeholders
may include locally affected communities or individuals and their formal and
informal representatives, national or local government authorities, politicians,
religious leaders, civil society organizations and groups with special interest,
the academic community, or other businesses.
Information on stakeholders and particularly organizations is important in
understanding stakeholder characteristics and potential opinions. Social
organizations present in every region of the Mamuju Regency include
womens organizations, including the Family Welfare Movement, youth
organizations such as the Forum of People and Police Partnership (FKPM),
cooperative or gotong royong (mutual cooperation) groups and other Village
Community Force Organizations (LKMD/LPM).
In 2004, cooperative movements in the Mamuju Regency consisted of 40
Village Unit Cooperatives or KUD (Koperasi Unit Desa) and 148 Non KUD
(Source: Monography of Mamuju Regency, 2004). No data are available for other
social organizations in the Mamuju Regency.
The identification and engagement of stakeholders is based on the criteria of
national and international guidelines as follows:

3.2.20.1 National Requirements


Head of the Environmental Management Bureau/Bapedal No. 08 of 2000
addressed Community Engagement and information transparency in the EIA
Process. Stakeholder identification is part of the assessment in the EIA
process, as detailed in:

Law No. 23 of 1997 regarding Environmental Management (replaced by


Law No 32 of 2009), especially article 5 concerning Community Right, i.e.
(1) Equally entitled to a good and healthy environment, (2) Entitled to
information about the environment linked, such as EIA, and (3) Entitled
to play a role in the framework of environmental management (role in
decision making, discussion, etc),

Government Regulation of Republic of Indonesia No. 27 of 1999 regarding


Environment Impact Assessment, article 33 (3) state that within 30 (thirty)
working days of the date of the announcement of the activities, interested

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-60

members of the community have the right to propose suggestions,


opinions and provide input regarding to the proponent,

Decree of Head of Environmental Impact Management Agency No. 08 of


2000 regarding Community Involvement and Information Availability in
The Process of An Environmental Impact Assessment,

Regulation of The State Minister of Environment No. 08 of 2006 regarding


Guidelines for the Compilation of The Analysis on Environmental
Impacts.

3.2.20.2 International Requirements


Stakeholder engagement is an international best-practice approach to
engaging with those most impacted by, or with interest in, a particular project
or issue. Identifying and engaging with stakeholders on a range of
environmental, economic and social issues creates value for a project through
promoting a common understanding of issues and a collaborative approach
to problem solving.
3.2.20.3 Stakeholders Mapping
Stakeholder mapping for the project included the following groups:
a.

Executive Branch

Ministry of Energy and Mineral Resources specifically targeting the


Directorate General of Oil and Gas

The Implementing Body for Oil and Gas Upstream Sector (BP Migas)

West and South Sulawesi Regional Offices of Energy and Mineral


Resources

West Sulawesi Regional Office of Marine Affairs and Fisheries

West Sulawesi Regional Office of Local Planning

Mamuju Regency Offices

b.

Legislative Branch

House of Representatives (DPR) specifically Commission VII (Energy,


Mineral Resources, Research & Technology and Environment)

West Sulawesi Regional and Provincial


Kota/Kabupaten) , Commissions C

c.

assemblies

(i.e.

DPRD

Key Opinion Formers

NGOs and independent organizations in West Sulawesi

Two different political orientations of NGOs emerged in Mamuju: the


developmentalism or center ideologies and the left leaning ideologies.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-61

The first types of NGOs are willing to cooperate and engage with
government programs and companies. Whereas, the latter refuse to
negotiate with both the government and private companies. Neither type
of NGOs is independent in nature. All are the sub-ordinates of and/or
former activists of the nationwide University Students Association.

Community Groups in the area where Statoil operates (including


religious, community and tribal leaders, and relevant farmer/fishermen
associations).

3.2.20.4 Typical Stakeholders


The following stakeholders have been identified for the project (Table 3-33).
Table 3-33

Stakeholder Identification and Areas of Interest

Stakeholders
Shareholders
Government

Workplace

Community

Marketplace
Environment,

Examples of Interest
Profit, performance,
direction
Taxation, VAT, legislation,
sustainability of natural
resources
Performance, Targets,
Wages, Job security,
Working conditions
Jobs available, involvement,
environmental and social
issues
Value for money, quality,
customer care

Examples of Stakeholder List


Statoil Global

Sustainability, natural
resources and systems

NGOs, Community
(direct/indirect affected),

National, Provincial and


regional governments
Senior management staff,
Non-managerial staff, Labor
Union
Villages in the surrounding
proposed site
Customers, suppliers,
consumers

A broader mapping of a company's stakeholders may also include:

Suppliers: Suppliers of a oil company supplies and utilities

Government regulatory agencies: AMDAL committee and other related


government agencies concerned with the regulatory and permit from the
national level to local; Ministry of Environment, Ministry of Energy and
Minerals Resources, BPH Migas, Ministry of Finance, Bapedalda, etc.

Industry trade groups: also known as trade associations are organizations


founded and funded by businesses that operate in a specific industry.

Professional associations: this


GAPEKNAS, INKINDO, etc.

NGOs and other advocacy groups:

Prospective employees and prospective Labor Unions: employees will


be developed and hired from local communities; experienced
professionals will be sourced from other regions of Indonesia and abroad.

will

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

include

KADIN,

GAPENSI,

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-62

Prospective customers: prospective customers will be from the West


Sulawesi area, other regions of Indonesia and abroad.

Local communities: fishermen and other villages communities in the


potential surrounding area of Project.

Public at large (Global Community): Society of Mamuju Regency, West


Sulawesi Province and Indonesia as a whole nation.

Schools: Local schools in the vicinity of the site and Mamuju Regency.

3.2.20.5 Public Consultation/Engagement


In order to support the implementation of oil and gas exploration (drilling)
activities in the Karama Block, Statoil conducted public consultation as part of
the internal Environmental Impact Assessment Study. Public consultation
activities were implemented as one of the efforts in disseminating
information about the plan of oil and gas exploration (drilling) activities
which will take place in the area.
Statoil conducted the public consultation in coordination with BP Migas
Kalsul representative office and West Sulawesi Province Energy and Mineral
Office. The purpose of public consultation is to socialize and inform the plan
of oil and gas exploration activity and explain of the potential environmental
impact of the drilling activity in Karama Block.
In particular, public consultation is intended:
1) To gather suggestions, opinions, and responses concerning the oil and gas
exploration activity.
2) To protect public interest surrounding the activity area from potential
impact that may arise from the project.
3) To establish an atmosphere of equal partnerhip between the parties
interest in oil and gas exploration activity in Karama Block.
4) To respect the right of all parties to obtain information relating to oil and
gas exploration activities in the Karama Block.
Public consultation was conducted in Mamuju which is the nearest city to the
project area as well Mamuju is the capital city of West Sulawesi Province and
relatively accessible for the entire stakeholders.
Public consultation was attended by the stakeholders that were members of
Coordinator/Facilitator/Mediator of the Implementation of Oil and Gas
Exploration/Exploitation of West Sulawesi Province which consist of
representative of government officials from related institutions in West
Sulawesi Province. The public socialization also attended by media and
NGO. Detail list of participants and documentation of the public
consultation/socialization event are presented in Appendix 4. This public
consultation is one model to engage stakeholder by giving them a description
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-63

of the activities to be carried out by the project. The questions, remarks,


concerns registered in the public consultation is presented in the Appendix
4.A.
During the public socialization discussion session, the participants were
actively involved in providing critical inputs associated with the plan of oil
and gas exploration drilling activity in Karama Block. The summary are as
follows:
1) Water quality aspect related to drilling cutting and drilling mud
management.
2) Social and Economics aspect related to job opportunity for local people,
community development program and compensation to rumpon owner
and fishing group affected by the activity.
3) More comprehensive socialization activities involving communities
proximity to the project location.
3.2.21

Statoil CSR Program


Statoil implemented high standard at its operation regarding Corporate
Social Responsibility (CSR) as stated in its governing document FR11 to cover
certain aspects such as Social risk management, Human rights, Transparency
and anti-corruption, Local spin-offs and Social investment management to be
incorporated in the CSR plan. In Indonesia, this CSR plan known as
Integrated Community Development Program (ICDP).
In mid 2008, Statoil began the first phase of its Integrated Community
Development Program (ICDP) in Mamuju, West Sulawesi. The program was
designed as an integrated, yet simple, achievable and measurable response to
basic local community needs.
Consensus within Statoils Corporate Social Responsibility (CSR)
Management Committee established the following principles for ICDP
activities: (1) to contribute directly to poverty alleviation, (2) to promote
active community participation and foster self-confidence, a sense of
ownership, responsibility and transparency among the communities
involved, (3) to be local resources-based for efficiency and effectiveness, (4) to
promote sustainability by creating community self reliance, (5) to be
innovative and provide added value to existing activities and approaches,
and (6) to collaborate with the appropriate authorities, promote support and
synergy and prevent overlapping functions.
Following more in-depth assessments and consultations with stakeholders in
the field, the ICDP decided to address three sectors: (1) Health (2) Education
and (3) Microeconomic development as main program to be implemented in
Mamuju.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-64

Health
In this sector, the program was divided into 2 major activities: (1)
empowerment for posyandu operators and traditional midwives through
training, and (2) provision of a mobile health clinic for free healthcare
services.
Statoil trough ICDP program conducted a training for posyandu operators
with the support of two local doctors: Dr. Sardiana Salam and Dr. Lindawati
Hariandja, the program has provided training for 10 traditional midwives
from Bela village, 12 posyandu trainees from Saletto Village and 10 posyandu
trainees from Bonehau Village. As the result of the training, the trained
mindwives continued to serve Posyandu and community with better
knowledge and proper apparatus.
Due to the lack of healthcare services in many areas, particularly more remote
places, the ICDP established a mobile health clinic program to respond
effectively to communities healthcare needs. The mobile health clinic
provides easy access healthcare to villagers, who would otherwise need to
travel for at least an hour along 10-15 km of difficult roads to the district
hospital Village heads have praised the socialization that preceded mobile
health clinic operations as well as its consistent and regular service. The
district government recognizes that mobile services could be effective in
reaching communities in more remote areas.
The mobile health clinic operates with help from a semi-volunteer doctor and
assistants who provide free healthcare and free medicines, and disseminate
information to communities on basic healthcare and how to handle illnesses.
The mobile health clinic operates in areas with limited, or no access to pos
yandu. With each visit it serves around 100 people, and in its operations, has
helped more than 2800 people. It usually operates from school playgrounds,
village heads homes or nearby land. Within less than 12 months of
operations, the mobile health clinic has provided healthcare services to
approximately 2860 people. The mobile clinic provided by the ICDP program
did not operate only during the presidential election and the Islamic fasting
month.
Education
In this sector the ICDP decided to implement 3 activities under this sector: (1)
to renovate or build school classrooms, (2) to provide basic school equipment
for students and (3)to combat illiteracy, particularly among adults.
As implementation of this program:
1) Statoil provided shoes, uniforms and books to around 150 students in 4
schools to increasing students motivation to attend schools.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-65

2) Build and renovated 5 schools in as follows constructed a modest new


preschool building in Karampuang Simbar on Karampuang Island,
renovation of the Keong Mas preschool on Karampuang Island,
construction of a new elementary school building in Limbong Bassi in
Simboro Archipelago Subdistrict, construction of a new junior high school
in Tamalea, Bonehau Subdistrict and build a new classroom in Dongkait,
West Tapalang
The evaluations showed that most of the projects have succeeded in
increasing school attendance. Most students are now proud of their schools,
and are happy to attend them. The new school in Tamalea, Bonehau
Subdistrict has been a great help to the students due to its closeness to their
homes and convenience ambient. Previously they should cram into small
living rooms in community members homes who are willing to contribute
for such a schooling process, due to unavailability of a school nearby. The
nearest school was a one-hour walk away across dangerous, flood-prone
terrain during the rainy season.
The illiteracy program began in December 2009 and will continue for 4
months, with 3 two-hour lessons a week. Eighty people from 4 groups are
participating in the program, all of whom are farmers aged between 15 and
40 years old living in Karampuang, Batu Pannu, Pasabu and Bonehau
villages. Most lessons are conducted in school buildings, including the ICDP
supported schools in Bonehau and Karampuang. The tutors are all local
teachers who have dedicated their time and energy to using the standard
illiteracy.
Economics sector
Mamuju District has substantial natural resources potential. More than 50%
of its populace depends on fishing and farming. However, poor management
capacity had meant these had yet to provide any significant contributions to
the local economy or development. Businesses with significant potential, but
needing strengthening, included seaweed, coconut, cacao and coffee
production. Community seaweed farming businesses, for instance, still had
difficulties in terms of working capital and technical capacity.
Accordingly, the ICDP implemented a local community enterprise
empowerment program, divided into several activities: (1) provision of
training for selected businesses, (2) provision of additional working and
investment capital (around IDR 25 million for each business) including
provision of simple apparatus to enhance production efficiency. A selection
process and criteria were applied to establish which enterprises would
receive support. This process was necessary for avoiding conflict among
community businesses and maintaining transparency among community
members.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-66

Following careful assessment and evaluations of the criteria set up by the


programme, the ICDP decided to support 3 community businesses. Two
were the Anjoro and Marassa coconut cooking oil (known locally as mandar
oil) production businesses in Kalukku, owned and managed by two womens
groups, each comprising 10 members. The other was involved in seaweed
culture on Karampuang Island.
3.2.22

Identification and Characterization of Indigenous Groups


In terms of the criteria outlined in paragraph 5 of the World Banks OD 4.20
on indigenous People, is as follows:
a.

A close attachment to ancestral territories and to natural resources in


these areas.

b.

Self-identification and identification by others as members of a distinct


cultural group.

c.

Often use a language different from the national language.

d.

Presence of customary social and political institutions.


They have their own customary social and political institutions (as
embodied in adat customary law). The Musyawarah, as commonly
practiced in Indonesia was also found practiced by this local
community.

e.

Primarily subsistence-oriented production.


Previously this is the main economic activity of the vast majority of
people in the project area. Today they had commercially cultivated the
lands for cash crops such like coconut, cloves, coffee and others.

f.

Vulnerability to being disadvantaged as social groups in the


development process.

g.

From the existing regulation applied in Indonesia the definition of


indigenous people is those who meet the government definition of
isolated communities under Ministerial Decree No. 5 of 1995.

h.

Isolated communities are described in groups of people who live or


wonder in dispersed isolated areas and follow a socio cultural system
which is isolated and left behind in comparison with the rest of
Indonesian society. Isolated is understood in terms of both geography
and culture where left behind is understood in terms of such measures
as health, education, housing, clothing and livelihood.

i.

Other terms and some characteristic of isolated communities developed


by Bappenas (National Planning and Development Agency) are as
follows:

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-67

Nomadic or semi nomadic lifestyle or living in small dispersed


bands;

Livelihood system strongly dependent on the natural environment


such as hunting, gathering, fishing or agricultural;

Inadequate standards of personal hygiene or cleanliness of


environment;

Meager or no clothing;

Low standard of housing;

Very limited knowledge and low use of technology;

Belief system that animistic;

Strong attachment to their cultural and belief system, which make


them cultural closed.

The Mamuju Regency can be categorized as a melting pot of people from


various ethnic persuasions. The regency is also the place where people of
Mandar, Bugis, Makassar, Toraja, Sadan, Manado and Java descent and
ethnicity reside and work. Other and unique ethnic that lives in Mamuju
Regency, among other are Karampuang Traditional Community.
Using identification criteria of indigenous group, it seems none can be
categorized as indigenous in Mamuju even in West Sulawesi.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-68

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

3-69

IMPACT EVALUATION AND CONTROL


The results of scoping are first presented in this section, followed by an
assessment of those aspects of the project scoped as having a potentially
significant impact on the environment and/or community. The assessment
has been conducted in line with the approach and method described in
Section 1.4.

4.1

SCOPING
Scoping aims to set the boundaries for the impact assessment, to identify
potential interactions between the project and environmental and social
receptors, identify the likely impacts of the Project that require further
investigation and to prioritize these in terms of potential significance.
Scoping for the project was conducted in August 2009 in Jakarta involving
key members of the project team and ERM consultants. During Scoping the
potential for interaction between proposed project activities and aspects of
the physical, biological, socio-economic environment was considered and a
judgement made on the potential significance of the resultant impact. All
those interactions considered to be not significant have been scoped out and
not considered further in the impact assessment. The results of Scoping are
presented in Figure 4-1 and summarised as:

Impacts to air quality and climate change due to emissions from the
transit of the drill ship to the site, operation of the drill ship, well cleanup/testing activities and from unplanned events (though this is discussed
separately);

Increased noise levels associated with the use of dynamic positioning,


operation of the drill ship and helicopters;

Impact to the seabed and benthic communities from well spudding


activities;

Impacts to water quality due to well spudding, disposal of drilling wastes


and casing and cementing activities;

Impacts on marine ecology (fish and pelagic flora and fauna, marine
mammals and reptiles) resulting from increased underwater noise levels
associated with the use of dynamic positioning, and from the movement
and operation of the drill ship;

Potential impacts to protected areas during the transit, including


mobilization and demobilization of the drill ship;

Impacts on waste disposal facilities due to wastes generated throughout


project activities;

Impact on fisheries from project activities; and

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-1

Impacts associated with unplanned events (eg. well blow-out and


collisions).

There has been further project definition since the time of Scoping and only
those aspects/activities determined as having the potential to cause
significant impacts are assessed further in this section. These are discussed in
detail in the following sections. Each subsection presents a summary of the
predicted impacts before and after any required mitigation and provides the
evaluation criteria and justifications for changes in the level of significance
from those made at the time of Scoping. Following the initial evaluation of
significance, the application of mitigation follows the principle of As Low As
Reasonably Practical (ALARP). Impacts assessed as not significant do not
require additional management or mitigation measures (on the basis that the
consequence of the impact is sufficiently small, or that the receptor is of low
sensitivity and/or that adequate controls are already included in the project
design). Mitigation of minor impacts is discretionary.
As described in Section 1.4.4, magnitude and value/sensitivity are looked at
in combination to evaluate whether an impact is significant and if so its
degree of significance. The principle is illustrated in Table 4-1.
Table 4-1

Evaluation of Impact Significance


Magnitude of Impact

Evaluation of Significance
Low
Value/ Sensitivity of
resources/ receptor

Medium
High

Low

Medium

High

Not
significant

Minor

Moderate

Minor

Moderate

ModerateMajor

Moderate

ModerateMajor

Major

A master table of impact significance is provided in Appendix 5. The


mitigation and management measures are carried forward as project
commitments and the implementation of these to reduce the predicted
impacts are detailed in the Environmental Management Plan (EMP) (Section
5).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-2

Scoping Matrix
Resources & Receptors Susceptible to Impacts

Utilities (eg. Landfills, waste treatment etc)

Public Health & Safety

Navigation

Aquaculture

Aesthetic Environmental Quality

Seascape &Visual

Tourism & Recreation

Employment & Income

Protected Areas

Social

Coral Outcrops

Birds/Seabirds

Marine Reptiles

Fish & Pelagic Flora & Fauna

Benthic Communities

Water Quality

Biological

Hydrodynamics

Seabed

Noise Levels (Airborne and Underwater)

Global Climate

Ambient Air Quality

Socio-Economic/ Employment

Accidental Events (Spills/ Dropped Objects)

Energy Usage

Waste Disposal

Suspended Solids

Effluent/ Discharges to Sea

Light emissions

Pollutant Emissions to Air

Noise Emissions

Physical Presence (Moving)

Physical Presence (Temporary)

Physical Presence (Permanent)

Physical

Fishery

ASPECT

ACTIVITY

Marine Mammals

Figure 4-1

RIG MOBILISATION/DEMOBILISATION
Transit of drill ship to site
Dynamic positioning
Vessel movements ( AHV, supply etc)
Rig demobilisation/mobilisation between well sites
Rig demobilisation off site
EXPLORATION DRILLING
Well spudding
Drilling (including mud and cuttings disposal)
Well completion (casing and cementing)
Drill ship operations (eg. Power generation, discharges,
drainage, etc) assume drill ship
Vessel movements (supply, chase boat etc)
Helicopter movements
Storage, handling & use of materials (eg. chemicals, drilling
fluids, etc)
Well logging, wireline and VSP
Well abandonment
UNPLANNED EVENTS
Dropped objects to marine water
Well blow-out/ shallow gas
Spills & leaks during drilling/ bunkering
Collision events

KEY
Description of significance of interactions:

An aspect of small magnitude

Interaction which is positive

An interaction that could be significant

An aspect of large magnitude

An interaction but not significant

An interaction that is significant

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-3

4.2

AIR QUALITY

4.2.1

Sources of Impact
The primary air emissions will be products of combustion (eg. CO2, CO, NOX,
SO2, particulates/smoke) and unburned hydrocarbons in the exhaust
emissions from vessels/equipment involved in the movement of the drill ship
to the project site; power generation on the drill ship, supply vessels, and
helicopter transfers. As stated in Section 2.6, emissions to air from
exploration drilling activities are estimated to be ~28,519 tonnes of CO2, ~412
tonnes of NOX, ~89 tonnes of SO2 and ~169 tonnes of CO and 17 tonnes of
NMHC (see Table 2.6).

4.2.2

Assessment Approach

4.2.2.1

Existing Conditions & Legal Standards and Guidelines (where relevant)


Air pollution is a major environmental problem in Indonesia (UOG, 2008).
Urban areas are mostly affected with transportation being the biggest (80%)
sector causing air pollution, followed by the industry sector, forest fires and
domestic activities.
Regulations of relevance to air emission standards for oil and gas activity in
Indonesia is the State Minister of Environment No. 13 Year 2009 regarding
Emission Standards from Stationary Sources for Oil and Gas Activity.
Emission standards provided by this regulation which will be used as a
benchmark for this assessment are indicated in Table 4-2.
Table 4-2

Air Emission Standards

Emission Standards
(mg/Nm3)
SO2
CO
NOx as NO2
CH4

TR1011

MOE Regulation No. 13


Year 2009
800
600
1,000
-

400
1,000
-

Indonesia is also extremely vulnerable to climate change (UOG, 2008).


Temperatures in Indonesia have increased by 0.3 oC since 1990 and are
expected to increase further by ~ 1.5 3.7 oC by 2100 (UOG, 2008).
Furthermore, changes is climate patterns have already been observed to affect
the timing of seasons in Indonesia; and anticipated future trends are expected
to result in a longer dry season and a more intense wet season (UOG, 2008).
Indonesia ratified the Framework Convention on Climate Change in 1994. As
part of this framework, Indonesia is required to mitigate climate change by
limiting its anthropogenic emissions of greenhouse gases and protecting and
enhancing its greenhouse gas sinks and reservoirs.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-4

4.2.2.2

Evaluation Criteria
The criteria used to define the magnitude and sensitivity of air quality
impacts are presented in Table 4-3 and Table 4-4.
Table 4-3
Magnitude
Low

Medium

Magnitude Criteria for Assessing Air Emissions


Definition

Short-term reduction in air quality but within benchmark


emissions limits

Project GHG emissions represent <1% of Indonesian total annual


estimated CO2 emissions
Occasional breach of the benchmark emissions limits over limited
periods
Project GHG emissions represent 1 5% of Indonesian total
annual estimated CO2 emissions
Repeated breaches of benchmark emissions limits over extended
periods
Project GHG emissions represent >5% of Indonesian total annual
estimated CO2 emissions

High

Table 4-4
Sensitivity
Low

Receptor/ Resource Sensitivity for Assessment of Air Emissions


Definition

Existing airshed in good condition (air quality is good); and

Medium

High

4.2.3

Sensitive receptor (i.e. coastal community) located > 1 km away


from the air emissions source.
Existing airshed showing some signs of stress (air pollution is
moderate); or
Concentration of sensitive receptors (ie. coastal community)
located within 0.1 1km from the air emissions source.
Existing airshed is degraded (air pollution is high); or
Sensitive receptors located within 100 m from the air emissions
source

Evaluation of Impacts
The potential well sites are located significantly offshore (i.e. the closest
potential well site to the coast is located > 30 km offshore). Emissions to air
will result in an increase in downwind air pollutant concentrations but
exceedance of air quality criteria at sea level is not expected due to rapid
dispersion and dilution of contaminants in the offshore environment.
The principal greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions from the project activities
offshore will be carbon dioxide (CO2) and hydrocarbons. CO2-eq emissions
from the exploration drilling program will be in the order of 29,161 tonnes for
the whole duration of the drilling period. These emissions will contribute to
Indonesias greenhouse gas emissions but this contribution is approximately
0.001% of total Indonesian annual GHG emissions of 3.014 billion tonnes.
Overall impacts are evaluated to be of Low magnitude but Medium
sensitivity (due to the vulnerability of Indonesia to climate change impacts)
with an overall impact of Minor Significance.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-5

4.2.4

Category

Impact before Mitigation

Residual Impact (after mitigation)

Magnitude of Impact

Low

Low

Value/sensitivity of
resources/receptor
Significance

Medium

Medium

Minor

ALARP

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts


Recommended mitigation to reduce air emissions include:

Implement an effective maintenance programme to optimise operations of


the engines to optimise fuel combustion and thus emissions;

Ensuring the use of low sulphur fuel;

Where practicable use of Marine Gas Oil as fuel rather than Heavy Fuel
Oil to reduce emissions.

4.3

NOISE LEVELS

4.3.1

Sources of Impact
Potential noise sources during the exploration drilling program include noise
from propellers and thrusters of the drill ship and support vessels, drilling
activities and helicopter transfers. Noise levels generated by using dynamic
positioning is indicated at 196 dB/1mPa at frequencies between 20 25 kHz;
and recorded underwater noise levels at source for supply and support
vessels range between 186 191 dB re 1Pa. Comparative noise levels for
different types of offshore vessels/rigs are presented in Table 2-10.

4.3.2

Assessment Approach

4.3.2.1

Legal Standards and Guidelines


No noise regulations exist for offshore operations. Noise standards stipulated
by the Decree of the Environmental Minister No KEP-48/MENLH/11/1996
are 75 dBA for industrial facilities. There are no noise standards for
underwater noise and its impact on ecology.

4.3.2.2

Assessment Criteria
Noise impact assessment criteria used in this assessment are presented below.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-6

Table 4-5

Magnitude Criteria for Impacts on Noise Levels

Magnitude
Low

Definition

No perceptible change or occasional but small change in noise


environment at closest sensitive receptors (ie. marine whales, turtles,
etc, protected areas, fisheries, fish spawning area, coastal
communities), insufficient to affect or alter normal day to day
activities/ behaviour;

Noticeable change in noise environment at closest sensitive receptor


(ie. marine whales, turtles, etc, protected areas, fisheries, fish
spawning area, coastal communities) over a longer time period (>1
hour) but insufficient to affect or alter normal day to day activities/
behaviour

Noticeable change in noise environment at closest sensitive receptor


(ie. marine whales, turtles, etc, protected areas, fisheries, fish
spawning area, coastal communities) of a level to encourage a change
to daily activity patterns/ behaviour

Medium

High

Table 4-6

Receptor/Resource Sensitivity for Assessment of Noise Levels

Sensitivity
Low

Medium

High

4.3.3

Definition

Sensitive receptor (ie. marine whales, turtles, etc, protected areas,


fisheries, fish spawning area, coastal communities) located > 1km
away from the noise sources

Sensitive receptors (ie. marine whales, turtles, etc, protected areas,


fisheries, fish spawning area, coastal communities) located within 0.5
1km from the noise sources

Sensitive receptors located within 500 m from the noise sources

Evaluation of Impacts
Offshore impacts
Underwater noise levels generated from exploration drilling activities will
primarily be from propellers and thrusters of support vessels, drilling.
Underwater noise has the potential to affect marine life, particularly marine
mammals and sea turtles, by altering the natural underwater noise
environment.
The effects of underwater noise on marine mammals can be behavioural (eg.
anthropogenic noise masks the noises used by cetaceans for communication)
or physiological (eg. high level made noise can damage the internal hearing
organs) (IWSNMW, 2008). Offshore activities (ie. mainly shipping) have been
known to cause behavioural disturbance to marine mammal populations
(IWSNMW, 2008).
Although a number of species of cetaceans (ie. whales, dolphins and
porpoises) and sea turtles are known to inhabit the waters offshore West
Sulawesi, very limited data is currently available on the occurrence and
distribution of these species in and around the proposed project site. The
area is a major spawning area for eels and also important for fisheries.
The exploration drilling program is estimated to take approximately 165
days. It is therefore likely that there will be short term disturbance to
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-7

marine organisms potentially present in the area. Possible impacts to marine


organisms could include:

Disruption to any underwater acoustic cues acoustic signals produced


by marine animals and used in a communicative sense with other
animals, or which are physical in origin but convey environmental
information, may be masked to some extent by continual intense noise;

Changes in behaviour levels of sound which are not sufficient to


produce avoidance behaviour may elicit behavioural changes which can
potentially disrupt normal activities;

Localised avoidance it is known that fish will actively avoid certain


types of sound, or leave an area in which intense sounds are being
produced.

Although the area is a major spawning area for eels and important for
fisheries, and the lack of data on marine mammals, impacts are evaluated to
be of low magnitude and medium sensitivity, with an overall impact of
Minor Significance.

Nearshore Impacts
Helicopter transfers will be made from Balikpapan to the proposed project
site. As there will be 2 trips per day throughout the duration of the
exploratory drilling, communities located nearby are likely to be disturbed by
noise generated. However it is expected that project related noise will not be
significantly higher than activities already being conducted at the supply base
and over a short duration, ie. initially as the helicopter takes off. As such
impacts are evaluated to be of low magnitude and low sensitivity with the
overall impact considered to be Not Significant.

Offshore impacts
Category

Impact before Mitigation

Residual Impact (after mitigation)

Magnitude of Impact

Low

Value/sensitivity of
resources/receptor
Significance

Medium

Minor

Nearshore Impacts
Category

Impact before Mitigation

Residual Impact (after mitigation)

Magnitude of Impact

Low

Value/sensitivity of
resources/receptor
Significance

Low

Not Significant

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-8

4.3.4

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts


Noise on offshore is a given impact and no mitigation measures are available
to reduce noise at the source during dynamic positioning. Nearshore noise
impacts may be reduced by limiting operation of chopper during night time

4.4

WASTE GENERATION AND DISPOSAL

4.4.1

Sources of Impact
Inappropriate handling, storage and disposal of non-hazardous and
hazardous wastes generated during drilling activities have the potential to
result in fouling/ contamination of the marine and onshore environments. A
typical waste inventory for drilling operations is presented in Section 2.6.
Wastes (including hazardous waste) generated offshore will include spent
chemicals, lube oil, hydraulic oil and batteries. Spent SBM will be returned to
shore for re-processing/ recycling (impacts from the discharge of drill
cuttings is discussed separately).
Inappropriate hazardous waste management has the potential to cause a
range of adverse effects including:

Toxic effects or physical damage to marine organisms;

Water pollution/ fouling/ contamination of the sea/ shoreline or onshore


environment (onshore storage, transport and disposal activities);

Risks of fire and explosion; and

Risks to human health.

4.4.2

Assessment Approach

4.4.2.1

Legal Standards and Guidelines


The legal framework of relevance to the assessment of waste generation and
disposal is based on:

Government Regulation No. 19 Year 1999 regarding Marine Pollution


and Damage Control: which states that everyone or company who is
dumping waste to the sea is obliged to get permit from Minister of
Environment.

The Government Regulation No. 18 Year 1999 related to the disposal of


hazardous and toxic waste: which states that hazardous and toxic wastes
can be stored up to a maximum of 90 days after which it must be disposed
at a suitable landfill facility; and

Regulation by the Minister of Energy and Mineral Resources No 045 Year


2006 regarding the Management of Drilling Mud, Waste Mud and Drill

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-9

Cuttings from oil and gas drilling activities.


regulation are presented in Table 4-7.
Table 4-7

Requirements of this

Requirements for the Management and Disposal of Drill Muds and


Cuttings

Testing

For offshore drilling activity, the processing of mud waste shall include LC50 96 hours
test, and drill cuttings shall include oil content test.

LC50 96 Hours test shall be conducted at least 1 (once) for mud waste in each well drilling
activity. The limit is equal to or more than 30,000 ppm SPP (Suspended Particulate Phase)

Drill cuttings with 10% or less hydrocarbon concentrations can be disposed to drilling site.
If it is more than 10%, than it should be managed according to the regulations.
Disposal Offshore

Final disposal of mud waste and drill cuttings may not be conducted in a sensitive area

Disposal of WBMS; should the result of the LC50 96 hours test be greater than or equal to
30,000 ppm, then mud waste may be disposed directly onto the sea. Should the test result
be smaller then 30,000 ppm then the muds will require further treatment

Disposal of SBMs & OBMs: SBMs and OBMs are to be reused and final disposal to be in line
with the regulations

Disposal of drill cuttings with an oil content less than or equal to 10% can be directly
disposed at sea. If oil content exceeds 10%, further treatment is required.
Disposal Onshore

Wastes will need to be segregated; ie. solid from liquid wastes, oil from liquid wastes and
segregation of dissolved solids.

TCLP Test and oil content tests will need to be conducted to determine a suitable area for
the disposal of muds and cuttings.

Discharge of SBM to the sea will arise due to drill mud retained on cuttings
after drying in the cuttings dryer system to an oil level content to around 30
50 g/kg or 3-5%.
In accordance with Minister of Energy and Mineral
Resources Regulation No 045 Year 2006, drill cuttings can be disposed to the
sea (in non-sensitive areas, if the oil content in drill cuttings is less than 10%
(10 g/kg). Statoil has internal policy (TR1011) drill cuttings can be disposed
to the sea if oil content is no more than 1%. If this limit can not be fulfilled
during drilling, the project will search a dispensation from Statoil corporate
head quarter to allow to dispose drill cuttting with oil content higher than 1%
but no more than 10% to the sea; if not, the drill cutttings will be transported
to shorebase in Balikpapan for further process.
Other regulations of relevance that relate to the preservation of the Indonesia
water environment are listed in Table 1-1.
4.4.2.2

Assessment Criteria
The magnitude of impact has been determined by considering the likely
volume of wastes that will be generated and how they will be managed and
disposed of to reduce impacts to the environment and society to ALARP (see
criteria in Table 4-8). Receptor sensitivity criteria reflect the capacity of waste
disposal services in Indonesia to cater for the wastes requiring disposal (see
Table 4-9).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-10

Table 4-8
Magnitude
Low
Medium

High

Table 4-9
Sensitivity
Low
Medium

High

4.4.3

Magnitude Criteria for Waste Generation and Disposal


Definition

Waste generated for disposal has been reduced to ALARP

Only some of the wastes generated for disposal have been reduced to
ALARP. Waste disposal sites are likely to experience some pressure in
dealing with the wastes generated (either due to type or quantity)

Little effort has been made to reduce waste generation to ALARP.


Wastes disposal sites will experience substantial difficulty in dealing
with the wastes generated.

Receptor/ Resource Sensitivity for Waste Generation and Disposal


Definition

Waste collectors and disposal sites have sufficient capacity to treat


waste (no export of waste)

Some constraints in the capacity of waste collectors and disposal sites


to handle and treat waste in an environmentally acceptable manner
are foreseen for non-hazardous wastes

Significant constraints in the capacity of waste collectors and disposal


sites to handle and treat waste in an environmentally acceptable
manner are foreseen for all waste types

Evaluation of Impacts
The bulk of wastes that will be produced from the exploration drilling
program are drill muds and cuttings. Spent WBMs and cuttings (both from
WBM and SBM drilling impacts of which are discussed in Section 4.5) will
be discharged into the sea while spent SBM will be disposed of onshore at a
suitable facility.
All hazardous and non-hazardous wastes generated will be disposed of at
existing approved/licensed onshore facilities in Balikpapan. The only nonhazardous waste generated offshore that will be discharged into the sea will
be galley food waste (food waste from kitchen and canteen) which will be
macerated prior to discharge.
SBM muds to be disposed onshore will be managed according to the
requirements of Regulation No 045 Year 2006. The exploration drilling
activities are not expected to generate significant volumes of waste. It is not
anticipated that pressure will be placed on exiting disposal facilities in
Balikpapan. Impacts are therefore evaluated to be of Medium magnitude
(taking a conservative approach to the likely volume of wastes which is
currently unknown) and Low sensitivity with an overall impact of Minor
Significance.
Category

Impact before Mitigation

Residual Impact (after mitigation)

Magnitude of Impact

Medium

Low

Value/sensitivity of
resources/receptor
Significance

Low

Low

Minor

Not Significant

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-11

4.4.4

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts


All wastes (non-hazardous and hazardous) generated offshore will be
managed in accordance with Statoils HSE waste management requirements
and legal requirements. Management of wastes should include:

Waste minimisation at source;

Waste segregation by type;

Transport of wastes in suitable containers to avoid leaks, wind blown


release of waste materials;

Completion of transportation consignment notes to document the transfer


of materials from offshore to onshore; and

Recycling of waste where possible.

These waste management requirements should be reflected in the vessels


Pollution Control and Waste Management Procedure.
Furthermore
management of waste on the drilling vessel, support and supply vessels will
be conducted in compliance with MARPOL Annex V requirements, which
includes the prohibition of disposal of garbage into the sea.
Provided wastes are managed appropriately, residual impacts associated
with the generation and disposal of wastes are reduced to Not Significant.
4.5

WATER QUALITY

4.5.1

Sources of Impact
The drilling program will generate drilling wastes and excess cement which
will be discharged into the sea. These include (as indicated in Section 2):

Spent WBMs; ~ 4,162 m3/well;

WBM and SBM cuttings: ~ 644 m3/well; and

Excess cement: ~ 780 m3 in total.

Drilling activities, including these discharges will result in increased


suspended solids within the water column.
Other discharges to water will include domestic and sanitary wastewater,
macerated food waste, rainwater runoff and ballast water discharges (see
Section 2). These also have the potential to reduce water quality in the
immediate vicinity of the drill vessel. However these have been scoped as
not having impacts of significance and not discussed further.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-12

4.5.2

Assessment Approach

4.5.2.1

Legal Standard & Guidelines


The legal framework of relevance to the assessment is based on the
Regulation by the Minister of Energy and Mineral Resources No 045 Year
2006 regarding the Management of Drilling Mud, Waste Mud and Drill
Cuttings from oil and gas drilling activities. Requirements of this regulation
are presented in Table 4-7. The Statoil requirement is that discharge of
cuttings should contain less than 1% oil content. If this limit can not be
fulfilled during drilling, the project will search a dispensation from Statoil
corporate head quarter to allow to dispose drill cuttting with oil content
higher than 1% but no more than 10% to the sea; if not, the drill cutttings will
be transported to shorebase in Balikpapan for further process

4.5.2.2

Assessment Criteria
Criteria to assess impacts on water quality are presented in Tables 4-10 and 411.
Table 4-10
Magnitude
Low

Medium

High

Table 4-11
Sensitivity
Low
Medium

High

4.5.3

Magnitude Criteria for Water Quality Impacts


Definition

Negligible change in water quality expected over a limited area with


water quality returning to background levels within a few meters; or

Discharges are well within specified limits

Temporary and localized change in water quality over a limited area


with water quality returning to background levels thereafter; or

Occasional breach of specified limits

Change in water quality lasts over the course of several months with
quality likely to cause secondary impacts on marine ecology; or

Routine exceedance of specified limits

Receptor/ Resource Sensitivity for Water Quality Impacts


Definition

Existing water quality is good and the ecological resources that it


supports are not sensitive to a change in water quality

Existing water quality is showing some signs of stress and/ or


supports some sensitive ecological resources that could be sensitive to
change in water quality

Already under significant stress and/ or is fragile to change with


respect to the resources it supports, will cause secondary ecological
impacts

Evaluation of Impacts
The waters within the Karama Block do support known sensitive receptors,
particularly near Karampuang Island and the adjacent shoreline of the
Mamuju Regency of West Sulawesi (see Figure 3-1), such as coral reef and

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-13

mangrove ecosystems, community fish ponds and seagrass culture.


On entering the sea, the discharge plume typically separates into an upper
and lower plume. The lower plume contains the majority of cuttings and drill
fluid mass while the upper plume comprises the liquid fraction and fine
gained silts and clays. The upper plume will tend to separate both laterally
and vertically and will be transported in the direction of the prevailing
currents.
Modelling of drill cuttings discharged was conducted for this study. The
modelling was conducted for two different scenarios; ie. under March and
October conditions (in terms of current and wind conditions). Key findings
from the study indicated that (see Appendix 1 for full results):

The drill cuttings and adhered muds would travel 30 to 40 km from the
drill centre before settling on the seabed;
Sedimentation rates would be orders of magnitude below 10 mg cm-2 day(which is the coral tolerance threshold criterion);

Total suspended solid (TSS) concentrations will exceed the 50 mg/l


threshold only at surface layers, while concentrations of TSS at the bottom
layers were less than 1 mg/l.

Overall, for both scenarios sedimentation rates were low. Suspended solids
in both cases were high (ie. above the 50 mg/l threshold for corals) for only a
brief period of time (~1 hour) and only near the surface of the well location.
Conclusions from the modelling study indicate that the discharge of mud and
drill cuttings pose a low environmental risk. SBMs retained on cuttings will
also be dried in the cuttings dryer system prior to discharge resulting in an oil
level content of around 30 50 g/kg or 3-5% (see point 4.5.2.1).
Based on the above explanation, impacts from the discharge of drilling wastes
are therefore evaluated to be of Low magnitude and Medium sensitivity with
an overall impact of Minor Significance.

4.5.4

Category

Impact before Mitigation

Residual Impact (after mitigation)

Magnitude of Impact
Value/sensitivity of
resources/receptor
Significance

Low
Medium

Minor

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts


Existing controls such as the cuttings dryer system together with Statoil and
legislative compliance sufficiently manage this issue and no additional
mitigation is required.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-14

4.6

SEABED & BENTHIC COMMUNITIES

4.6.1

Sources of Impact
The scoping process based on the project information available during
scoping identified project activities such as well spudding, anchoring,
positioning and ballasting of the drill ship to be potentially significant in
terms of impacts on the seabed and benthic communities. Since scoping
however, more details of project activities have been finalized; eg. a drill ship
will be used for drilling with dynamic positioning and as such there will be
no anchoring activities, also the drill ship will be coming from a nearby field
and as such issues associated with ballasting (ie introduction of new species,
etc) is no longer considered to be an issue. This section therefore focuses on
impacts associated with well spudding and resulting disposal of drill cuttings
on the seabed.

4.6.2

Assessment Approach

4.6.2.1

Legal Standard & Guidelines


The legal framework of relevance to the assessment is based on the
Regulation by the Minister of Energy and Mineral Resources No 045 Year
2006 regarding the Management of Drilling Mud, Waste Mud and Drill
Cuttings from oil and gas drilling activities. Requirements of this regulation
are presented in Table 4.7.

4.6.2.2

Assessment Criteria
Criteria to assess impacts on seabed and benthic communities are presented
in Tables 4.12 and 4.13.
Table 4-12
Magnitude
Low
Medium

High

Table 4-13
Sensitivity
Low
Medium

Magnitude Criteria for Sediment Quality and Impacts on Benthic


Community
Definition
Minimal effects on sediment quality/minimal seabed disturbance
Short-term localized (<500 m) but severe disturbance/effects on
sediment quality and with medium to long-term (>5 years) secondary
impacts to ecological resources
Activities result in/contributes to significant seabed disturbance/
impacts/change to sediment quality with long-term (>10 years)
secondary impacts to ecological resources

Receptor/Resource Sensitivity for Sediment Quality and Impacts on


Benthic Community
Definition
Existing sediment quality is good and the ecological resources that it
supports are not sensitive to a change in sediment quality
Existing sediment quality is showing some signs of stress and/ or
supports some sensitive ecological resources that could be sensitive to
change in sediment quality

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-15

Sensitivity
High

4.6.3

Definition
Already under significant stress and/ or is fragile to change with respect
to the resources it supports, will cause secondary ecological impacts

Evaluation of Impacts
The top hole section of each well will be drilled without a casing in place and
as such drill cuttings and muds will be discharged directly on the seabed in
proximity to the well. Only WBMs are being proposed for the top hole
sections. Additionally, cuttings from both WBM and SBM drilling will be
discharged into the sea.
The seabed at the project site is classified as silt and silty-clay with low
content of sand and gravel. The types of benthic species present in the area
are not well understood. It is expected however that only a small area
immediately surrounding the well will be affected from the drilling of the top
hole section. During the drilling of the rest of the well sections, cutting will
be discharged through a discharge chute located on the vessel (ie. 12 m below
the water surface). As indicated in Section 4.5 above, modelling results have
indicated that cuttings discharged will travel approximately 30 40 km and
as such will be spread out over a wider area; impacts to benthic communities
are therefore reduced.
Considering that only WBMs will accumulate near the well surface, impacts
are evaluated to be of Low magnitude and Medium sensitivity (as the type of
benthic species present is currently unknown) with an overall impact of
Minor Significance.

4.6.4

Category

Impact before Mitigation

Residual Impact (after mitigation)

Magnitude of Impact

Low

Low

Value/sensitivity of
resources/receptor

Medium

Low

Significance

Minor

Not Significant

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts


Measures to reduce impacts on the seabed include:

Conducting a comprehensive baseline of the area to determine the likely


species present and their sensitivity prior to beginning project activities.

Provided implementation measures are effective and no species of significant


ecological/ commercial value have been identified, residual impacts are
considered to be not significant.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-16

4.7

FISHERIES

4.7.1

Sources of Impact
Project activities have the potential to impact fisheries in the area. Impacts
associated with noise, discharged of drill muds and cuttings, and spills on
fish stock are discussed in Sections 4.3, 4.5 and 4.8. This section focuses on
the hazards posed by rig mobilization/transit to project site and presence of
support vessels and suspended wellheads.

4.7.2

Assessment Approach

4.7.2.1

Legal Standard & Guidelines


Act No 45 year 2009 jo 31 year 2004 on Fisheries concerning fisheries
management including optimize the management of fish resources, the
preservation of fish resources, fish cultivation and spatial arrangement.

4.7.2.2

Assessment Criteria
Criteria to assess impacts on fisheries are presented in Tables 4.14 and 4.15.
Table 4-14
Magnitude
Low
Medium
High

Definition

Activities will not affect/ cause constraints on resource users

Activities will result in limited interference/constraints on resource


users

Activities will result in significant interference/constraints on resource


users

Table 4-15

Receptor/ Resource Sensitivity for Impacts on Fisheries

Sensitivity

Definition

Low fishing activities in the area; or

Activities will result no loss of income.

Moderate fishing activities in the area; or

Activities will result in some loss of income.

Significant fishing activities in the area; or

Activities will result in significant loss of income.

Low
Medium
High

4.7.3

Magnitude Criteria for Impacts on Fisheries

Evaluation of Impacts
As indicated in Section 3.7.5, the project area is surrounded by artisanal
fisheries. Fishing activities are an important source of food and income for
communities in the area. Some fishers also practice the use of rumpon or
Fish Aggregation Devices (FAD); based on data collected during the seismic
program in 2008, approximately 81 rumpon were identified in the Karama
Block and its vicinity. The main fishing areas were identified as extending
approximately 2 10 km from the shore.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-17

The drill ship will transit to the project site from a nearby field and as such it
is not anticipated that it will impact fishing activities in a significant manner.
Supporting vessels movement during drilling activity from and to
Balikpapan will impact fishing activity in Karama Block and its vicinity.
There is potential collision of drilling supporting vessel movement with
rumpon and fishing gear might occur. Drilling activities however will be
conducted over 165 days and during this period an exclusion zone around
each well will be necessary. It is therefore likely that there may be
disturbance/constraints on fishing activities from removal of rumpons and
any trawling, long line activities but these would be temporary and once
activities are concluded the exclusions zones removed.
Upon completion of drilling the wellheads will remain in place; ie 2 m above
seabed that will be addressed in Drilling UKL-UPL document (provided
approval is received from Ministry of Environment), which may pose a minor
constraint to fishing activities. If approval is not received to leave the
wellheads on the seafloor in UKL-UPL document, the wellheads, casing,
piling and other obstructions will be removed to a depth of 15 ft below the
seafloor and all obstructions removed.
Based on the above explanation, impacts from drilling activities are therefore
evaluated to be of Medium magnitude and Medium sensitivity. Overall
impacts are therefore considered to be of Moderate Significance.

4.7.4

Category

Impact before Mitigation

Residual Impact (after mitigation)

Magnitude of Impact

Medium

Low

Value/sensitivity of
resources/receptor

Medium

Medium

Significance

Moderate

Minor

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts


The following mitigation measures are recommended to reduce/ manage
potential impacts:

Notify fishing authorities of planned activities;

Maintain communication with local communities/fishermen notifying


them of planned activities, location of wellheads and understanding their
concerns;

Ensure procedures are in place for dealing with claims for damaged
fishing gear etc. from local fishermen; and

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-18

Conduct rumpon mapping and identify rumpon that should be removed


within 1 km radius from drilling area.

The residual impact based on the effective implementation of these guidelines


will reduce the significance of impacts from Moderate to Minor Significance.
4.8

UNPLANNED EVENTS

4.8.1

Sources of Impact
Unplanned events scoped as being of potential significance includes a
blowout and collisions both of which can result in the uncontrolled release of
hydrocarbons. These are discussed further in the following sections.

4.8.2

Assessment Approach

4.8.2.1

Legal Standard & Guidelines


Regulations of relevance include;

4.8.2.2

Presidential Regulation No. 109 of 2006 concerning emergency response


for oil spillage in the sea;

Ministry of Environment Decree No. 200 of 2004 concerning standard


criteria for environmental damage and guidelines for determination of
status of sea grass colonies;

Ministry of Environment Decree No. 201 of 2004 concerning standard


criteria for environmental damage and guidelines for determining the
extent of damage to mangroves.

Assessment Criteria
Criteria to assess impacts from unplanned events are presented in Tables 416 and 4-17.
Table 4-16
Magnitude
Low

Medium
High

Magnitude Criteria for for Impacts resulting from Unplanned Events


Definition

No. of receptors affected is limited to a few isolated individuals/


organisms/cases and they recover quickly with only short-term
discomfort

No. if receptors affected extends to a wider area or receptors affected


sustain long-term environmental/ health impacts

No. of receptors affected is considerable or those that are affected


sustain permanent environmental/ health impacts or a fatality occurs

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-19

Table 4-17
Sensitivity
Low
Medium
High

4.8.3

Receptor/ Resource Sensitivity for Impacts resulting from Unplanned


Events
Definition

Receptor can readily absorb/ adapt and recover quickly from the
impact

Receptor experiences some short-term difficulty in absorbing/


adapting and recovering from the impact

Receptor experiences considerable, long term difficulty in absorbing/


adapting and recovering from the impact

Evaluation of Impacts
In general oil spilled into the marine environment undergoes a number of
physico-chemical changes depending on the type and volume of oil spilled,
the prevailing weather and sea conditions. Typically evaporation and
dispersion act to remove oil from the sea surface. Spilled oil containing light
hydrocarbon fractions (eg. diesel) tend to evaporate quickly compared to
heavier (crude) spills. The evaporation process will be enhanced by warm air
temperatures and moderate winds and will produce considerable changes in
density, viscosity and volume of the spill.
Modelling was performed to assess potential environmental impacts in the
event of an accidental release of hydrocarbons due to an annulus blowout at
the Anoman Well (UTM easting 673819.520008, northing 9732223.28191, Zone
50S WGS84,). The model calculated the spatial extent of the oil released, the
direction and time in which the spill may travel, the thickness of the surface
slick (compared to significant thickness thresholds), and the magnitude and
duration of potentially toxic dissolved aromatic component concentrations
(compared to no-effect thresholds). Three release scenarios (for spills
volumes between 3,000 10,800 m3/d) were evaluated for two separate
months (March and October) and two separate wind conditions (at the end of
the northwest monsoon season and end of the southeast monsoon season.
In all scenarios the risk to the water column from aromatic concentrations
were above the no-effect threshold limits (ie. a 96-hour toxicity threshold of
310 ppb) and therefore having the potential to affect marine organisms.
Significant effects on fish are unlikely since mobile organisms will be able to
avoid the areas where concentrations are at the highest. Benthic organisms
are unlikely to be impacted by dissolved aromatics released by spills. At
more risk are birds and other species, and coastal communities making
contact with a surface hydrocarbon slick, particularly near the shoreline.
Sensitive ecosystems exist in coastal area of Mamuju Regency which are
susceptible to oil spill are thin strip of mangrove, coral reef, sea grass and
aquaculture i.e. tambak (brackish water shrimp/fish culture) and sea grass
cultivation.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-20

Impacts from oil released from an annulus blowout pose a medium to high
risk impact to organisms which contact the surface oil, depending on the
quantity released and time before any potential response efforts can contain
the release. Spills of this nature pose a low risk of acute toxic effect to the
aquatic biota. Several shorelines are however at risk within the first few days
after a release.
In all scenarios, spills ended up reaching the shoreline between one to five
days from release (see Table 4-18). Though much of the oil was predicted to
evaporate, the simulations indicate that oil components will persist,
remaining on the water surface before eventually reaching the shorelines.
The modelling predicts that the coastline of West Sulawesi will be hit first
followed by areas (to a lesser extent) along the South Sulawesi coast.
Karampuang Island was identified to be at high risk for shoreline impacts in
all scenarios except Scenario 1-3 and Scenario 1-4; however, even in these two
near-miss cases, the island could have been hit under slightly different
conditions.

1-1
1-2
1-3
1-4
2-1
2-2
2-3
2-4
3-1
3-2
3-3
3-4

Surface
Area
Affected
(km2)

Time to
shore (hrs)

Scenario

Summary of Model Results


Shoreline
Affected
(km)

Table 4-18

Release

Month

Winds

8,000 m3/day for 5 days


8,000 m3/day for 5 days
8,000 m3/day for 5 days
8,000 m3/day for 5 days
3,000 m3/day for 120 days
3,000 m3/day for 120 days
3,000 m3/day for 120 days
3,000 m3/day for 120 days
10,800 m3/day for 120
days
10,800 m3/day for 120
days
10,800 m3/day for 120
days
10,800 m3/day for 120
days

March
March
October
October
March
March
October
October
March

Typical
Maximum
Typical
Maximum
Typical
Maximum
Typical
Maximum
Typical

171
93
36
84
504
289
277
299
592

41
33
78
26
51
34
113
44
51

1,703
1,013
1,958
1,447
1,478
1,301
1,270
1,157
1,944

March

Maximum

316

108

1,342

October

Typical

286

106

1,380

October

Maximum

359

54

1,244

Fortunately the occurrence of a blowout is very rare, and extensive


preventative/ control measures will be implemented to reduce the likelihood
of such events. Based on statistics by the International Association of Oil &
Gas Producers on blowout frequencies (for deep well), the likelihood of a
blowout occurring would be in the order of 1 blowout for every 695 wells
drilled (OGP, 2010). Average annual frequency of accidents related to drill
ships between 1990 2003 was 6.3 (total number of accidents recorded within
this period was 35).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-21

Statistics on oil spills occurring during offshore drilling activities indicate that
the likelihood of a large spill is low (this is based on statistics for oils spills
during drilling in Atlantic Margin between 1990 - 2002); the probability of an
oil spill occurring is one spill in every 29.6 wells drilled (AHL, 2004). The
most likely spills arise from loading and bunkering operations between the
drill ship and supply vessels.
Even with the application of the latest industry standards and consideration
of the highest standards of safety, accidental events may still occur.
Blowout/spills occurring within the Karama Block have the potential to have
significant impacts on the environment including potential health impacts.
An uncontrolled blow out could take many days or months to bring under
control. Impacts are therefore evaluated to be of high magnitude and high
sensitivity with an overall impact of Major Significance.
Category

4.8.4

Impact before Mitigation

Residual Impact (after mitigation)

Magnitude of Impact

High

Medium

Value/sensitivity of
resources/receptor
Significance

High

Medium

Major

Moderate

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impacts


The following measures should be implemented to reduce the likelihood and
consequence of accidents occurring:

Development of an Oil Spill Contingency Plan that identifies


responsibilities of relevant personnel, defines spill response actions (eg.
for Tier 1, Tier 2 and Tier 3), describes actions to be taken in the event of a
spill, communication procedures, reporting procedures, etc, including
ensuring that spill response mechanisms are in place and located in a
logistically suitable location (ie. based locally) that enables quick response
time;

Provision, implementation and training of all staff on an Emergency


Prevention and Response Plans, including emergency training exercises;

Ensure response equipment is available on site in areas identified as


sensitive;

Ensuring a model can be run live in case of a spill;

Ensure of notices to other mariners of activities in the area; and

Presence of support vessels to warn other vessels in the area.

Provided mitigation measures are implemented and effective, residual


impacts associated with accidental impacts are considered to be of Moderate
Significance.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-22

4.9

SOCIO-ECONOMIC BENEFITS

4.9.1

Sources of Impacts
Socio-economic impacts that may occur due to the drilling exploration
program is the creation of employment opportunities and demand for goods
and services, ie. positive benefits from employment and service contracts.

4.9.2

Assessment Approach
Impacts have been assessed in terms of the likely duration and size of socioeconomic change. There are no specific performance expectations of
relevance to this assessment other than that project benefits on the
community should be enhanced to the extent possible.

4.9.2.1

Evaluation Criteria
The magnitude used for the assessment on socio-economic impacts are
presented in Table 4-19.
Table 4-19
Magnitude
Low

Magnitude Criteria for Assessment of Socio-Economic Impacts

Medium

High

4.9.3

Definition
Host population does not experience any socio-economic or sociocultural affects (positive or negative) as a result of the Project
Host population experiences some socio-economic or socio-cultural
affect in the short term but which leads to some change in their preProject situation
Host population experiences considerable socio-economic or sociocultural affects in the long term resulting in significant and permanent
change in their pre-Project situation

Evaluation of Impacts
The Karama Block Drilling Exploration Program will require ~ 140 personnel
(ie. on the drill vessel and supply and support vessels) who are likely to be
skilled operators/ technicians. Thus the potential for the Project to directly
engage the local people is limited.
Indirectly however, the Project itself and the workforce will demand
numerous services and supplies, both from specialist contractors and service
providers (eg. mud supply and handling contractors, waste contractors etc.)
and from the local market (eg. rental accommodation, food and
transportation providers). This has the potential to positively impact the
community surrounding the Balikpapan Supply Base however it is unlikely
to bring benefit to the population in the Mamuju Regency. The extent of the
Project and its duration means that any such benefits would however be
temporary and of low to medium magnitude. Overall, the Project is expected
to have at most a Minor Positive impact on the local economy.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-23

Category
Magnitude of Impact
Value/sensitivity of
resources/receptor
Significance

4.9.4

Impact before Mitigation


Low - Medium

Residual Impact (after mitigation)


Medium

Not Significant - Minor


Positive

Minor Positive

Mitigation Measures & Residual Impact


To enhance benefits from employment/ stimulation of the local economy it is
recommended that engagement of Indonesian-based service and supply
contractors are prioritised.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-24

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

4-25

ENVIRONMENTAL MANAGEMENT PLAN

5.1

INTRODUCTION
The objective of an Environmental Management Plan (EMP) is to provide the
delivery mechanism for the commitments made in this EIA study. To assist
Statoil in implementing these recommendations, they have been brought
together as a register of actions and management plans within this outline
EMP. The aims of the EMP are:

5.2

To ensure continuing compliance with legal requirements and Statoil


policies/ Health, Safety and Environment (HSE) principles;

To provide the initial mechanism for ensuring that measures identified in


the EIA to mitigate potentially adverse impacts are implemented;

To provide a framework for mitigating impacts during project execution;

To provide assurance to regulators and stakeholders that their


requirements with respect to environmental performance will be met;

To undertake monitoring to demonstrate that predictions made within


the EIA are valid; and

To provide a framework for the compliance auditing and inspection


programs that will enable Statoil to be assured that its aims with respect
to environmental performance are being met.

STATOILS HSE PRINCIPLES


The HSE management system is an integral part of the Statoil total
management system. Statoils aim is to have zero impact on the environment.
Key environmental principles include:

Acting according to the precautionary principle;

Assessing all relevant environmental and social issues and minimizing


negative impact on the environment;

Complying with applicable legislations and regulations;

Setting specific targets and improvement measures based on relevant


knowledge of the affected area;

Consulting and cooperating with relevant stakeholders;

Working actively to limit the effects of fossil fuels on climate change by


addressing energy efficiency, emissions trading, etc;

Seeking to maintain biodiversity and key ecosystem functions and values;


and

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
DRILLING EIA

5-1

Minimising the generation of waste.

The Karama Block exploration program will be conducted in line with


Statoils HSE management system.
5.3

ENVIRONMENTAL MANAGEMENT PLAN


Table 5-1 summarizes the key identified environmental impacts associated
with the Karama Block exploration drilling program and mitigation measures
that shall be implemented to prevent unacceptable impacts. For each issue,
the mitigation, management and monitoring measures are presented along
with specific actions required to implement these measures, responsibilities,
timing and a means of verification.
The following should be noted when interpreting the table:

The significance of residual impacts assumes that the recommended


mitigation measures have been fully implemented and that they have
been effective. Thus regardless of the level of significance presented, the
mitigation measures are required; and

Actions have been numbered sequentially for each row item.


Responsibilities for implementing each numbered action, a timeframe and
a means of verifying that the action has been completed are then
presented with the same numbering (ie. Action # 1 is to be implemented
by the # 1 responsible person etc.).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
DRILLING EIA

5-2

Table 5-1
Issue

A. Air
Quality

Activity/
Source of
Impact
Exhaust
emissions
from
vessels,
equipment,
etc

Environmental Management Plan


Impact

Contribution to
climate change

Mitigation/Enhancement Measures

Implement an effective maintenance


programme to optimise operations of
the engines to optimize fuel
combustion and thus emissions;
Ensure the use of low sulphur fuel;
Where practicable, ensure the use of
Marine Gas Oil as fuel rather than
Heavy Fuel Oil to reduce emissions;
and

Significance
Required Actions
Responsibility
Timing of
of Residual
for
Actions
Impact
Implementation
Minor
(1) Incorporate all
(1) Statoils
(1) Prior to
significance
mitigation measures
Procurement
contracting
into the contractual
Manager
or starting
documents of
(2) Site
drilling
drilling contractor
contractors
works
(2) Translate
(3) Statoils
(2) Prior to site
requirements into
Exploration
works
operating
Manager
starting
instructions/
(3) Fortnightly
procedures and
throughout
brief personnel
the drilling
involved
exploration
(3) Audit contractors
program
adherence to the
measures

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

Means of Verifying
that Actions are
Complete
(1) Requirements
included in
contract
documents
(2) Requirements
included in
drilling
program
management
instructions
and
procedures
(3) Audit records

STATOIL
DRILLING EIA

5-3

Issue

Activity/
Source of
Impact
B. Waste
Handling,
generation
storage and
and disposal disposal of
nonhazardous
and
hazardous
wastes
generated

E. Water
and
sediment
quality &
benthic
community

Impact

Mitigation/Enhancement Measures

Significance
Required Actions
of Residual
Impact
Potential
Waste Management System (vessels
Not
(4) Incorporate
contamination of the Pollution Control and Waste Management significant
requirements into
marine environment Procedure), detailing:
the contractual
documents and

Waste minimisation at source;


vessels Pollution

Waste segregation by type;


Control and Waste

Transport of wastes in suitable


Management
containers to avoid leaks, wind blown
Procedure
release of waste materials;
(5)
Audit contractors

Completion of transportation
adherence to the
consignment notes to document the
measures
transfer of materials from offshore to
onshore;

Recycling of waste where possible;


and

Compliance with MARPOL Annex V


requirements (including the
prohibition of disposal of garbage into
the sea) on the drilling vessel, support
and supply vessels.
Discharge of Contamination of the
(6) Incorporate
Conducting a comprehensive baseline Not
drilling
marine environment
significant,
requirements into
of the area to determine the likely
wastes and (reduction of water
provided no
contractor
species present and their sensitivity
wastewater quality, increased
species of
contractual
prior to beginning project activities.
discharges
suspended solids,
ecological
documents
and seabed
value/
(7) Contract to conduct
blanketing from
sensitivity is
the baseline survey
settling of drill
discovered
and analysis
cuttings) leading to
toxic effects/
smothering of marine
fauna and sensitive
marine habitats,
including coral reef
and mangrove
ecosystems, as well

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

Responsibility
Timing of
for
Actions
Implementation
(4) Statoils
(4) Prior to
Procurement
contracting
(5) Fortnightly
Manager
throughout
(5) Statoils
exploration
Exploration
drilling
Manager
program

Means of Verifying
that Actions are
Complete
(4) Requirements
included in
contract and
vessel
procedures
(5) Audit records

(6) Statoils HSE (6) Prior to


Manager &
start of
Procurement
drilling
Manager
(7) Prior to
(7) Statoils HSE
start of
Manager
drilling

(6) Requirements
included in
contract and
vessel
procedures
(7) Survey
results/ report

STATOIL
DRILLING EIA

5-4

Issue

F. Fisheries

Activity/
Source of
Impact

Impact

as community fish
ponds.
Drill vessel Constraints on
mobilization fisheries in the area
/ transit to
project site
and
presence of
support
vessels

G.
Unplanned
events

Blowout/
collision
resulting in
spills

Marine pollution and


secondary impacts
on ecology and
community health
and safety

Mitigation/Enhancement Measures

Significance
of Residual
Impact

Notifying fishing authorities of


planned activities;
Acquisition and compensation of the
rumpons will follow the Governors
Decree
Maintaining communication with
local communities/ fishermen
notifying them of planned activities
and understanding their concerns;
Conduct rumpon mapping and
identify rumpon that should be
removed within 1 km radius from
drilling area; and
Ensuring procedures are in place for
dealing with claims for damaged
fishing gear etc. from local fishermen.
Development of an Oil Spill
Contingency Plan that identifies
responsibilities of relevant personnel,
defines spill response actions (eg. for
Tier 1, Tier 2 and Tier 3), describes
actions to be taken in the event of a
spill, communication procedures,
reporting procedures, etc, including
ensuring that spill response
mechanisms are in place and located
in a logistically (ie. based locally)
suitable location that enables quick
response time;
Provision, implementation and
training of all staff on an Emergency
Prevention and Response Plans,
including emergency training

Minor
significance

(8) Incorporate within


and implement a
Stakeholder
Engagement Plan
(9) Translate
requirements into
operating
instructions/
procedures and
relevant personnel

(8) Statoils HSE (8) Prior to


Manager,
start of and
Public
during
Relations
drilling
Officer &
activities
Exploration (9) Prior to
Manager
start of and
(9) Statoils HSE
during
Manager
drilling
activities

(8) Stakeholder
Engagement
Plan
(9) Grievance
mechanism

Reduced to
ALARP

(10) Prepare Oil Spill


Contingency Plan
and circulate to
contractors
(11) Provide the
necessary logistics
onshore required to
manage a large spill
(12) Provide necessary
training and
conduct drills to
support emergency
prevention and
response plan
(13) Provide necessary
equipment on vessel
to implement

(10) Statoils HSE


Manager and
Exploration
Manager
(11) Statoils HSE
Manager
(12) Drilling
contractor
(13) Statoils
Exploration
Manager
(14) Statoils
Exploration
Manager

(10) Oil Spill


Contingency
Plan in place
(11) Temporary
onshore
logistical base
to respond to
spills
(12) Training
records and
daily tool box
talk minutes
(13) Equipment on
vessel/
logistical base
(14) Audit records

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

Required Actions

Responsibility
for
Implementation

Timing of
Actions

Means of Verifying
that Actions are
Complete

(10) Prior to
start of
drilling
activities
(11) Prior to
start of
drilling
activities
(12) Prior to
start of and
during
drilling
activities
(13) Prior to
start of
drilling
activities

STATOIL
DRILLING EIA

5-5

Issue

Activity/
Source of
Impact

Impact

Mitigation/Enhancement Measures

Significance
of Residual
Impact

exercises;
Ensuring a model can be run live in
case of a spill;
Ensure of notices to other mariners of
activities in the area; and
Presence of support vessels to warn
other vessels in the area.

Required Actions

requirements
(14) Audit contractors
adherence to
requirements

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

Responsibility
for
Implementation

Timing of
Actions

Means of Verifying
that Actions are
Complete

(14) Fortnightly
throughout
drilling
activities

STATOIL
DRILLING EIA

5-6

5.4

ROLES AND RESPONSIBILITIES

5.4.1

Role of Statoil Project Team


Ultimate responsibility for environmental performance of the Project lies with
Statoil. Statoil will have responsibility for monitoring the performance of the
contractor and also the overall Project. Where the measures set out in the
EIA/ EMP do not result in the achievement of objectives, Statoil will work
with the contractor to refine the measures.
On a day to day level, implementation of HSE responsibilities shall be
cascaded down throughout the organizational hierarchy incorporating all
staff involved in the implementation of the Project. Key players referenced in
this EMP as having day to day responsibilities for HSE management include:

Exploration Manager who shall have day to day responsibility for the
implementation of all aspects of this EMP;

Senior Coordinator Drilling Procurement who shall be responsible for


ensuring relevant requirements are translated into contractual and service
documents; reviewing the competency of contractors and service
providers to implement the necessary HSE requirements and holding
contractors and service providers to the implementation of these
requirements through monitoring and evaluation;

HSE Manager who shall be responsible for overseeing the


implementation of this EMP by assisting the Exploration and
Procurement Managers as relevant; preparing sub-management plans for
implementation by contractors as outlined in Table 5-1; auditing and
supervising contractors for adherence with the provisions of this EMP;
liaising and cooperating with government authorities on environmental
matters as relevant; preparing work and cost schedules for the monitoring
program; arranging for reporting of the results of the monitoring;
maintaining records and reports to document implementation; and
periodically reviewing and if necessary revising the contents of this plan
to ensure it fully reflects on site circumstances; and

Government and Public Affair (GPA) Officer who shall be responsible


for developing and implementing a Stakeholder Engagement Plan for the
Project, maintaining regular and positive dialogue with stakeholders in
line with this plan, documenting the results of engagement, recording and
addressing grievances and managing compensation processes on behalf
of Statoil.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
DRILLING EIA

5-7

5.4.2

Role of Drilling Contractor


The contractor will be responsible for ensuring compliance with all relevant
legislation, Statoil procedures as well as adherence to all environmental
controls and mitigation measures specified in the EIA report. This includes:

Ensuring drill vessel procedures and management practices reflect the


requirements presented in this EMP and that the measures are fully
implemented;

Ensuring relevant personnel, including sub-contractors, are aware of and


implement their responsibilities with respect to HSE management
through induction, competency evaluation, job descriptions and
employment contracts, training, briefings and disciplinary action;

Assigning responsibility for HSE management on the drill vessel to a


named individual and ensuring that they are equipped to complete their
role with respect to this EMP;

Conducting daily inspections of the drill vessel to check implementation


of the measures presented in this EMP, identify any actual impacts and to
remedy digressions immediately;

Reporting any spills or identified impacts to Statoil immediately and


assisting in developing and implementing subsequent mitigation actions;

Managing materials, fuels, chemicals, wastes, wastewater and equipment


etc on the drill vessel so as to prevent contamination of the marine
environment or the generation of excessive air emissions, debris, waste,
sediment, or noise;

Managing, preventing and developing emergency plans in case of any


accident or emergency; and

Passing relevant requirements to sub-contractors and services providers


and monitoring and enforcing their implementation.

Contractual documentation between Statoil and the contractor shall include a


clear description of the contractors obligations to implement the proposed
control and mitigation measures for the potential environmental impacts
identified in the EIA and EMP for the project.

5.5

COMPETENCIES AND TRAINING


For implementation of this EMP, and project environmental performance to
be successful, personnel responsible for its implementation will need to have
the relevant competencies, capabilities and job descriptions to enable them to
carry out their responsibilities efficiently and effectively. Taking into account
the role descriptions presented in Section 5.4, competencies of allocated staff
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
DRILLING EIA

5-8

shall be reviewed in line with existing Human Resources and Training


evaluations and development plans and programs implemented for
individual staff members to address gaps.
In addition to competencies in environmental management, personnel
involved in the implementation of this EMP shall also be required to have the
following competencies:

5.6

Good appreciation of the activities relevant to the Project (as relevant);

Sound understanding of the Project HSE performance expectations; and

Leadership and program execution skills.

INSPECTION, AUDIT AND CORRECTIVE ACTIONS


Regular audits and inspection (random spot checks) shall be undertaken
throughout the execution of the Project as outlined in Table 5-1. The
objectives of these reviews are to:

Check that practices conform with planned arrangements including


implementation of mitigation and management measures and compliance
with legal and project commitments;

Identify where existing planned arrangements (eg. measures outlined in


the EMP) do not meet the needs of Statoil or can be improved; and

Establish information which can be used by management to continually


improve performance.

Three types of audits shall be undertaken:


1.
2.
3.
5.6.1

Daily inspections by the Drill Vessel Master;


Fortnightly audits by Statoil personnel; and
Ad-hoc audits in response to accidental events.

Daily Inspections
Visual site inspections shall be conducted by the Drill Vessel Master on a
daily basis. All results of site inspections shall be documented and submitted
to Statoil.

5.6.2

Fortnightly Audits
Fortnightly conformance and compliance audits shall be conducted by Statoil.
All results of audits shall be documented and retained. Instances of nonconformances shall be reported to the relevant Supervisors to ensure that
appropriate corrective and/or preventive action is taken.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
DRILLING EIA

5-9

5.6.3

Ad-hoc Audits
These shall be triggered by an incident and will specifically seek to
understand the cause of the incident and identify a solution.

5.6.4

Audit Reporting
All audit findings shall be reviewed by the Statoil HSE Manager, and where
corrective actions are deemed necessary, specific plans (with designated
responsibility and timing) shall be developed aimed at addressing the specific
finding, any underlying issues and ultimately achieving continuous
improvement in performance.

5.7

REPORTING AND STAKEHOLDER COMMUNICATION


Contractors shall be required to report issues immediately to Statoil in the
event that monitoring and/ or inspection identifies issues which need to be
rectified immediately. Results of monitoring will indicate whether or not the
mitigation measures are effective. If a particular mitigation measure is found
to be ineffective, contractors shall be asked to stop work and take the
necessary corrective actions.
The results of monitoring, and any corrective actions implemented, shall be
shared with relevant stakeholders.
Dialogue with stakeholders will also be an important means of confirming
impact severity, particularly with respect to impacts on fisheries. A
Stakeholder Engagement Plan for the Project shall be prepared as stated in
Table 5-1 and shall include engagement to monitor impacts.

5.8

ENVIRONMENTAL MONITORING
Some potential environmental effects can be predicted with a degree of
precision. A number of effects can however only be accurately evaluated
once the activity commences (through impact monitoring). Monitoring will
be required in order to demonstrate compliance with legal limits and Statoils
project requirements (compliance monitoring).
Monitoring will also provide verification of the overall design and
effectiveness of the implemented control measures. The key objectives of
Statoils proposed monitoring activities are as follows:

To monitor discharges and emissions to ensure compliance with relevant


standards and Statoils environmental objectives;

To provide an early indication that any of the environmental control


measures or practices are failing to achieve acceptable standards; and

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
DRILLING EIA

5-10

To determine whether environmental changes are attributable to the


Karama Block exploration drilling program, other activities or as a result
of natural variation.

In developing the monitoring program, the following considerations and


strategies have been applied:

Consistent with internationally and locally acceptable practices;

Responsive to detect environmental changes/ trends;

Logistically practical; and

Cost effective.

The following sections outline the recommended monitoring activities for the
exploration drilling program.
5.8.1

Seabed Sediments/ Benthic Community


It is recommended that a sediment/ benthic monitoring survey be conducted
to determine the type of benthic communities present and if there are any
sensitivities associated with these prior to beginning drilling activities.
Indicative parameters to be monitored are presented in Table 5-2.
Table 5-2

Monitoring of Sediments/ Benthic Community

Parameter
Physico-chemical

Hydrocarbons

Metals
Ecology

5.8.2

Specification
Particle size distribution (PSD)
Total organic carbon (TOC)
Redox potential
Total hydrocarbons
Total petroleum hydrocarbons
Total extractable hydrocarbon
PAH (Poly Aromatic Hydrocarbons)
Ba, Cr, Hg, Ni, V & Zn
Macrobenthos - taxonomic name and numbers of
individuals of all identified species

Drilling Waste
Drilling wastes will be managed by Statoils Drilling Contractor. It is
recommended that the following information will be inventoried during
exploration drilling activities and presented to Statoil by the Drilling
Contractor:

Drilling muds and chemicals used to drill the well which should include
the information provided in Table 5-3; and

Collection of specific mud and cutting samples during drilling, for


analysis as outlined in Table 5-3.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
DRILLING EIA

5-11

Table 5-3

Monitoring of Drilling Mud & Chemical Use: Drilling OCN


Reports

Parameter
Reporting parameters

5.8.3

Specification
Mud type (WBM /SBM & their application)

WBM composition & concentration of use

SBM composition & concentration of use

Specific mud constituents including, mercury


compounds, cadmium compounds, persistent
components (synthetic and hydrocarbons), and heavy
metals

Total quantity of each mud type used

Total quantity of each mud type discharged, loss to


formation and recovery plus estimation of total quantity
of base oil discharged

Lithology and estimated volume of cuttings discharged

Analytical parameter

As indicated in Minister of Energy and Mineral Resources


Regulation No. 045 Year 2006

Responsible Person

Drilling Contractor

Waste Management
Recommended monitoring requirements throughout drilling activities for
waste generation include the following:

5.8.4

An inventory of waste types and volumes generated and transported to


shore for disposal will be maintained. A log of hazardous waste
produced and sent to shore for disposal will also be kept; and

Waste consignment notes for all wastes transferred to shore will be held.

Accidental Events/ Upset Conditions


A log of non-routine events, spills and accidents will be maintained
throughout drilling operations and the necessary root cause analysis will be
undertaken.

5.9

OIL SPILL CONTINGENCY/ RESPONSE PLAN


An Oil Spill Contingency Plan (OSCP) will be developed by Statoil for the
Karama Block Exploration Drilling project, taking into account Presidential
Regulation No. 109 of 2006 concerning emergency response for oil spillage in
the sea, and incorporated in the drill ships Shipboard Oil Pollution
Emergency Plan (SOPEP).
In the event of an oil spill, the response operations will be managed in
accordance with a tiered approach outlined in the OSCP/SOPEP. Response
measures will be managed/ directed from the emergency management
coordination centre (ie. at a suitable logistical location in terms of being able

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
DRILLING EIA

5-12

to respond to a spill) and, depending of the size/volume of the spill, will


include the following measures:

Prevent, control or stop outflow of oil from the source;

Deploy booms close to the source of the spill to contain the spread of oil;

Monitor the movement and behaviour of the oil spill;

Activate further response operations, to protect sensitive resources if


necessary; and

Determine appropriate clean-up priorities and other response measures.

All wastes generated during the oil spill response and clean-up operations
will be disposed of according to the relevant legal requirements.
5.10

REVIEW AND REVISION


The EMP will be a live document. It will be reviewed by the Project team
prior to start of and during project activities, in consultation with Statoils
HSE department, on a periodic basis during the project. The EMP will be
updated as needed to provide effective management of environmental issues
associated with exploration drilling program.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
DRILLING EIA

5-13

CONCLUSIONS

6.1

INTRODUCTION
Statoil Indonesia Karama As (Statoil) and partners plan to undertake an
exploration drilling program of three deep-water exploration wells at Karama
Block in the Makassar Strait, offshore West Sulawesi Province in 2011. The
purpose of this project is to discover the oil or gas targets identified from
interpretation of 3D seismic survey data.
An Environmental Impact Assessment (EIA or AMDAL) is not required
under Indonesian Regulation for exploration drilling activities. This IA is
being completed in line with Statoils corporate requirements and covers only
the exploration drilling activities for the Karama Block.

6.2

ENVIRONMENTAL CONCERNS
The key environmental concerns identified as requiring consideration for
impact assessment were:

Air quality;

Noise generation;

Waste generation and disposal;

Water quality;

Fisheries;

Unplanned events.

Baseline conditions of the project area covering physical, biological, and


socio-economic environment were comprehensively described based on
available secondary data. Data gaps were evident for information or
secondary data sources on fisheries, benthic communities, sensitive marine
receptors such as marine mammals, turtles, mangrove, coral reef and sea
weed/sea grass ecosystems in the project area.
6.3

OUTCOME OF THE IMPACT ASSESSMENT


The outcome of the impact assessment is presented in Section 4 and is
summarised as:

Overall impacts to air quality are evaluated to be of Low Magnitude but


Medium Sensitivity (due to the vulnerability of Indonesia to climate
change impacts) with an overall impact of Minor Significance;

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

6-1

Offshore impacts from noise generation;


o

Onshore impacts from noise generation


o

6.4

As the area is a major spawning area for eels and important for
fisheries, and taking a conservative approach due to the lack of
information on fisheries and other sensitive marine receptors, impacts
are evaluated to be of Medium Magnitude and High Sensitivity, with
an overall impact of Moderate Significance with mitigation.

Impacts are evaluated to be of Low Magnitude and Low Sensitivity


with the overall impact considered to be Not Significant.

Provided wastes are managed appropriately, residual impacts associated


with the generation and disposal of wastes are reduced to Not Significant

Impacts from the discharge of drilling wastes are evaluated to be of


Medium Magnitude and Medium Sensitivity with an overall impact of
Moderate Significance;

Considering that only WBMs will accumulate near the well surface,
impacts to seabed and benthic communities are evaluated to be of Low
Magnitude and Medium Sensitivity (as the type of benthic species present
is currently unknown) with an overall impact of Minor Significance;

Impacts from drilling activities are therefore evaluated to be of Medium


Magnitude and Medium Sensitivity. Overall impacts are therefore
considered to be of Moderate Significance and with mitigation of Minor
Significance.

Even with the application of the latest industry standards and


consideration of the highest standards of safety, accidental events may
still occur. Blowout/ spills occurring within the Karama Block have the
potential to have significant impacts on the environment including
potential health impacts. An uncontrolled blow out could take many
days or months to bring under control. Impacts are therefore evaluated to
be of High Magnitude and High Sensitivity with an overall impact of
Major Significance.
However, provided mitigation measures are
implemented and effective, residual impacts associated with accidental
impacts are considered to be of Moderate Significance.

SUMMARY CONCLUSION
On the basis of this assessment, it is concluded that, provided the in-place
mitigation and control measures are effective and all impacts associated with
the Project are managed appropriately as suggested no significant impacts are
anticipated for the drilling of the exploration wells in the Karama Block.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

6-2

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

6-3

APPENDICES
Appendix 1:

Oil Spill and Drilling Cuttings Modeling Result

Appendix 2:

Analytical Result of Seawater Quality

Appendix 3:

Analytical Result of Seabed Sediment Quality

Appendix 4:

Stakeholder Engagement Meeting

Appendix 5:

Master Impact Tables

Appendix 6:

Drilling Chemical Characteristics

APPENDIX 1
OIL SPILL AND DRILLING CUTTINGS
MODELING RESULT

ACCIDENTAL OIL SPILLS

1.1

SIMULATION DESIGN
Modeling was performed to assess potential environmental impacts in the
event of an accidental release of hydrocarbons due to an annulus blowout at
the Anoman Well (UTM easting 673819.520008, northing 9732223.28191, Zone
50S WGS84,). The model calculated the spatial extent of the oil released, the
directions spills may travel, the thickness of the surface slick (compared to
significant thickness thresholds), the time of travel, and magnitudes and
durations of potentially toxic dissolved aromatic component concentrations
(compared to no-effect thresholds). The model assumes that there is no
intervention to reduce and manage the magnitude of spill such as use of
dispersants and recovery mechanisms.
A generic crude oil was assumed to be released from the sea floor. Three
release scenarios were evaluated for two separate months and two separate
wind conditions. The two months evaluated were March (the end of the
northwest monsoon season), and October (the end of the southeast monsoon
season). For each of the two months, typical and maximum wind scenarios
were run. In the first four scenarios (Scenarios 1-1 through 1-4), the release
was assumed to be 8000 m/d over a period of five days. The models were
run for 18 days to evaluate the fate of the five-day release. In the second four
scenarios (Scenarios 2-1 through 2-4), the release was assumed to be 3000
m/d for 112 days. In the third four scenarios (Scenarios 3-1 through 3-4), the
release was assumed to be 10800 m/d over a period of 112 days. These
models were run for 120 days to assess the fate of the 112-day release.
Due to the unavailability of long period current meter records, deterministic
modeling was chosen over stochastic modeling to examine the probable
locations spills could travel. Modeled currents and metocean measurements
were selected from 2008, a year when a complete data set was available.
Though the results are limited to this representative year, and the conclusions
lack the range of potential outcomes associated with a probabilistic
assessment, the results are considered appropriate for an assessment of the
risks and quantification of the impacts associated with an oil spill. The
specific shorelines impacted and area of oil covering the water surface will
naturally vary in an actual emergency based on the winds, currents, and
release characteristics.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

Table 1-1 Spill modeling scenarios


Scenario
Scenario 1-1
Scenario 1-2
Scenario 1-3
Scenario 1-4
Scenario 2-1
Scenario 2-2
Scenario 2-3
Scenario 2-4
Scenario 3-1
Scenario 3-2
Scenario 3-3
Scenario 3-4

Month
March
March
October
October
March
March
October
October
March
March
October
October

Duration
5 days
5 days
5 days
5 days
112 days
112 days
112 days
112 days
112 days
112 days
112 days
112 days

Volume (m/d)
8000
8000
8000
8000
3000
3000
3000
3000
10800
10800
10800
10800

Winds/Currents
Typical
Maximum Wind
Typical
Maximum Wind
Typical
Maximum Wind
Typical
Maximum Wind
Typical
Maximum Wind
Typical
Maximum Wind

Bathymetry was obtained from the US NOAA GEODAS Design-a-Grid


system (NOAA 2009) providing depth measurements every 1.9 km. An oil
spill grid (Figure 1-1) was constructed to cover an area 477 km in the northsouth direction (349 grid cells), and 188 km in the east-west direction (149
grid cells). Each grid cell near shorelines was subdivided into 16 sub-grid
cells (Figure 1-2) for higher resolution when modeling shoreline oiling.

Figure 1-1 Oil spill grid area (gray) and spill release loca-tion at the Anoman Well

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

Figure 1-2 Close-up view of the oil spill grid with shoreline sub-grid

Using GEMSS (Generalized Environmental Modeling System for


Surfacewaters) and its oil spill module, COSIM (Chemical/Oil Spill Impact
Module), each spill was simulated using 500 independent particles to
represent the spill mass. Each particle was affected by currents, winds,
randomized dispersion factors, and weathering. The GEMSS-COSIM
modeling system produces time-varying mass balances and tracks the fate of
the released chemical constituents into the various phases and forms
including the surface slick, shoreline, atmosphere, water column (dissolved
or entrained), and sediment deposition. Fate is computed for the following
processes: advection, spreading, evaporation, dispersion, dissolution,
emulsification, photo-oxidation, sinking, sedimentation, and biodegradation.
Summaries of scenario results are provided in terms of the locations of
surface oiling, time of travel for the surface oil, maximum dissolved
concentrations of aromatics and the potential shoreline areas covered. The
model was run until all oil mass had left the water surface onto the land, air,
water column, or left the model domain.
COSIM performs simultaneous mass balances for a full suite of specific
chemicals or groupings of chemicals with similar properties. This feature
enables greater modeling precision by applying chemical specific rates for

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

parameters such as solubility, evaporation, and solids partitioning. The


theoretical formulation of COSIM can be found in Kolluru et al. (1994).
GEMSS and its component modules have met agency approval among
federal and state governments within the U.S. Outside the U.S., GEMSS and
its various software modules have also been approved by regulatory agencies
in the Bahamas, Qatar, India, Australia, UK, and Canada.
1.2

METOCEAN DATA
Modeled currents were provided for the Indonesian Throughflow by the U.S.
Naval Research Laboratory (NRL) from the results of the EAS NCOM 1/16
degree sigma/z Ocean Model. The NRL provided current velocities in an
evenly spaced grid across 17 locations from 118 E to 119 E and 17 locations
from 2 S to 3 S across 70 unevenly spaced depths from 0 m (surface) to 5400
m.
Table 1-2
Depth (m)
0
2
4
6
8
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
50

NRL modeled current depths


Depth (m)
55
60
65
70
75
80
85
90
95
100
110
120
130
140

Depth (m)
150
160
170
180
190
200
220
240
1000
1100
1200
1300
1400
1500

Depth (m)
1600
1800
1000
1100
1200
1300
1400
1500
1600
1800
2000
2200
2400
2600

Depth (m)
2800
3000
3200
3400
3600
3800
4000
4200
4400
4600
4800
5000
5200
5400

Though the spills were simulated to originate from the sea floor, the oil was
calculated to rise quickly to the surface where it was primarily affected by
surface currents. The surface currents in March and October 2008 differed
greatly. Surface currents modeled by the NRL in March 2008 averaged 0.22
m/s and flowed primarily towards the northwest, north, northeast, and east
(Figure 1-3). Currents in October 2008, however, traveled only to the south at
an average of 1 m/s (Figure 1-4).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

Figure 1-3

March 2008 current rose

The convention for current direction is going to, i.e., the direction the water is heading.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

Figure 1-4 October 2008 current rose

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

Figure 1-5 Grid of NRL model output locations for current values

Local meteorological data (winds) were obtained from the Asia Pacific Data
Research Center (APDRC) for coordinates 118.6 E Longitude, 2.1 S Latitude.
While both March and October had significant winds from the east and west,
wind rose diagrams (Figure 1-6 and Figure 1-7) showed an additional strong
influence of winds from the southwest in March 2008 and from the northeast
in October.
For maximum wind scenarios, winds were fixed at a constant direction
heading east towards the shoreline. The wind speeds were calculated as the
maximum value for the given scenarios month (March or October) over all of
the years available from the APDRC data (1999 through 2009).
Air temperature and dew point temperature were obtained from the U.S.
Department of Energys National Renewable Energy Laboratory (NREL) for
the Ujung Pandang-Hasanudin Airport (Station WAAA) in southwestern
Sulawesi.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

Figure 1-6 March 2008 wind rose


The convention for wind direction is coming from.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

10

Figure 1-7 October 2008 wind rose

1.3

OIL PROPERTIES AND TOXICITY


In the absence of a site specific chemical assay, the modeled crude oil was
based on a chemical assay of a crude oil from a confidential offshore drilling
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

11

site. The oil chosen was an intermediate weight oil to represent properties as
a mid-point between heavy and light crudes. A typical intermediate API
gravity of 32.75 and a moderate viscosity of 8.2 cp at 25 C were assigned to
describe the whole oil for calculations of oil spreading and dispersion on the
water surface. For calculations of the fate (evaporation, emulsification,
entrainment, etc.) and water column dissolved concentrations, the oil was
further described into specific components (cuts) based on chemical assays
of the intermediate crude oil. The models cut-specific properties are listed in
Table 1-3. COSIM calculates the fate and of each component of the oil
separately. The total volume released is divided between each oil cut based
on the mass proportions described in the assay. The mass proportions are
converted into volumetric proportions based on each cuts average density.
The crude oil components properties are described by seven cuts:

C6-C7 Aromatics

C8-C9 Aromatics

Naphthalenes

nC4 Butane

nC5 Pentane

nC6 Hexane and other Paraffins

Resins / Heavy Residuals

The C1-C5 aromatics together comprised less than 2.5% of the total mass and
were combined into the C6-C7 category (though the properties of C6-C7
aromatics were used).
For the toxicological assessment, the sum of the dissolved aromatic
hydrocarbons was calculated to assess the potential for acute aquatic impacts
to biota from narcosis. Toxicity thresholds for aromatics are found in the
literature as a function of 96-hour LC50 concentrations. According to
recommendations by Nilsen et al. (2006), threshold values based on effect
limits as a function of species sensitivity to specific dissolved oil components
were determined. Using this methodology, the threshold for aromatics may
be up to 99 ppb for PAHs, and 2523 ppb for monoaromatics. The toxicity of
the dissolved components will change over time as various compounds will
leave the dissolved state at different rates. For a conservative threshold,
including components less likely to be solubilized, a weighted average of the
each components threshold concentration was calculated to be 310 ppb,
derived from the components found in the whole oil (Table 1-4). Threshold
values would be higher if the proportioning was based on the dissolved
components at each time step. Note that the geometric mean of the C6 and C7
threshold concentrations was taken to compute the C6-C7 aromatic threshold
since the LC50 values from which the thresholds were derived are assumed to
be log normally distributed. Similarly, geometric means were taken for C8-C9
aromatics and two categories of naphthalenes provided by Nilsen et al.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

12

Table 1-3 Properties of representative intermediate crude oil


Cut Name

C6-C7
Aromat
ics

C8-C9
Aromatic
s

Naphtha
lenes

nC4
Butane

nC5
Pentane

nC6 Hexane
Other
Paraffins

Boiling point (C)

105.9

136.1

271.7

-0.5

36.1

68.7

400.0

Melting point (C)

N/A

N/A

47.2

N/A

N/A

N/A

200.0

% volume in liquid

11.7

11.7

7.0

1.7

2.0

20.4

45.5

Solubility (mg/l) 25C

719.0

169.0

6.0

72.0

0.0001

9.5

0.00025

Molecular
weight (g/mole)
Vapor pressure
(Pa) 25C
Density (gm/cc)

90.0

106.2

170.3

58.1

72.2

86.0

350.0

5.14E+
03
0.868

1.28E+03

9.65E-01

1.15E+05

6.00E+04

6.89E+04

1.00E-03

0.867

0.997

0.584

0.626

0.664

0.985

N/A

N/A

N/A

385.20

357.27

331.45

N/A

Latent heat of
liquid (KJ/Kg)
Dynamic Viscosity (cP)

0.583

0.703

0.780

0.210

0.217

0.314

N/A

Diffusion coefficient

0.091

0.074

N/A

0.0971

0.086

0.0779

N/A

*Note: Unavailable (N/A) values were replaced internally by model calculated estimates

Table 1-4 Threshold concentrations by oil component cuts (whole oil)

1.4

Resins and
Heavy
Residuals

Oil Cut

% Volume

C6-C7 Aromatics
C8-C9 Aromatics
Naphthalenes
nC4 Butane
nC5 Pentane

11.7
11.7
7.0
1.7
2.0

Threshold
5% Lethal Risk
(ppb)
1332.0
179.3
44.7
3100.0
549.7

nC6 Hexane and other Paraffins


Resins and Heavy Residuals

20.4
45.5

311.9
4.4

RESULTS
The model results are presented as color contour maps representing locations
that may have significant surface oiling or shoreline oiling at some point after
a spill until the surface slick has all evaporated, hit shoreline, or left the model
domain. Significant surface oiling is defined as any oil having a thickness
above the minimum thickness threshold, a value that protects aquatic biota
from being smothered. This threshold is calculated as 0.1 m, an order of
magnitude below a minimum smothering thickness of 1 m (French et al,
1999; NOAA 1996). Thicknesses less than the 0.1 m threshold are typically
invisible to the eye (Koops, 1985). In COSIM, the threshold thickness is
translated into units of mass per surface area (0.04 g/m) calculated from the
thickness threshold multiplied by the oil density. Model output is presented
for those locations with surface oil mass per unit area equal to or greater than
the 0.04 g/m threshold.
Travel time diagrams use color contours to identify the time when oil was
present at a given location on the water surface. The diagrams are adjusted to
only show locations with significant surface oiling. Note that oil may contact
the surface of a location, pass through, and then return back to the same

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

13

location at a later time. The travel time color will be associated with the latest
time the oil contacted that location.
Mass balance plots describe the fate of the oil as time-varying percentages of
the total mass for the five primary phases: the surface oil, dissolved,
entrained (whole oil droplets suspended in the water column), stranded on
shorelines, and mass evaporated or volatilized into the atmosphere.
1.4.1

Scenario 1-1 March (Typical Winds), 5 day release, 8000 m/d


In the first scenario, during March a five day constant release of crude oil rose
from the sea floor to the surface within a day and traveled to the east. Before
contacting the shore, the trajectory spread both north and south from the well
location until contacting shoreline after 40 hours (Figure 1-8). The shorelines
of Karampuang Island were oiled within 6 days after the initial release. After
a week from the initial release, the surface oil spread towards the shores of
South Sulawesi. Some oil on saturated shorelines returned to the sea and
oiled other shorelines to the south. A total of approximately 170 km of
shoreline accumulated oil resulting from this release. The surface area with
significant oil thickness is shown in Figure 1-9. Significantly thick oil
contacted a cumulative area of 1703 km. The travel time diagram (Figure
1-10) shows significant oiling was estimated to be present up to 20 days after
the release.
Aromatics dissolved into the water column are computed to exceed the
toxicological threshold of 310 ppb, reaching maximum concentrations in
many areas in the plume up to 1000 ppb. To quantify the amount of threshold
exceedance, the highest concentrations at each grid cell location over depth
and time were computed (Figure 1-11). In this scenario, 161 km of surface
area had concentrations that at some point exceeded the 310 ppb threshold.
Vertically within the water column, besides at the release location, the largest
dissolved concentrations were calculated mostly at the surface layers of the
model beneath the surface slick before diluting with depth. Though the risk
of exposure to benthic organisms is minimal, pelagic species remaining in the
concentrated plume near the surface can be at risk of experiencing narcotic
effects from dissolved aromatics. Exceeding a toxic threshold does not
necessarily indicate an acute toxicological response will definitely occur, but
that the risk of fish mortality is elevated. For mortality to occur, an organism
needs to be exposed to lethal concentrations for a significant duration.
Additionally, organisms have varying sensitivities such that an identical
exposure may or may not cause mortality to the same species. The threshold
was conservatively estimated and based on studies wherein test organisms
died after a 96-hour exposure. Shorter durations correlate with exponentially
larger concentrations necessary to cause an equivalent lethal effect. If
organisms are only briefly exposed to lethal concentrations before traveling
below or away from the area, mortality can be avoided.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

14

Figure 1-8 Scenario 1-1 trajectory and shoreline oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

15

Figure 1-9 Scenario 1-1 significant surface oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

16

Figure 1-10 Scenario 1-1 time of travel (for significant oiling)

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

17

Figure 1-11 Scenario 1-1 maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

18

The mass balance plot (Figure 1-12) describes the fate of the oil over time
transferring into various phases and forms. The model ended after 18 days
when the final 8% of oil remaining on the water surface contacted shorelines
adding to the 23% already on the shores. After 18 days, 18% of the initial
mass had transferred to the atmosphere. The dissolved concentration reached
a plateau around 26% of the total mass after a week. Entrained oil mass was
initially 100% when first released from the sea floor, but decreased to
negligible levels after 10 days. The remaining mass adsorbs to suspended
solids and sinks to the sediments.
Scenario 1-1 Mass Balance
100
Surface
Atmosphere
Dissolved
Shoreline
Entrained

90
80
% of Total Mass

70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0

24

48

72

96

120

144

168

192

216

240

264

288

312

336

360

384

408

432

456

Hours from Release

Figure 1-12

1.4.2

Scenario 1-1 mass balance

Scenario 1-2 March (Maximum Winds), 5 day release, 8000 m/d


Scenario 1-2 was identical to Scenario 1-1 except the winds were held constant
at 8.2 m/s, blowing towards the east. This speed is the maximum easterly
wind speed in March measured over all 11 years of meteorological data (1999
through 2009). These high winds dominated the movement of oil on the
surface, causing a more focused area of shoreline oiling within 33 hours after
the initial release (Figure 1-13) including Karampuang Island. Three days
after the 5-day release period ended, all of the oil had left the water surface.
The total water surface area covered with a significant thickness of oil at some
time during the 8-day event was 1013 km (Figure 1-14). About 93 km of
shoreline was oiled in all.
Figure 1-15 shows the travel time, indicating the northern part of the shoreline
was contacted before the southern areas.
As in Scenario 1-1, the dissolved aromatics dissolved into the water column is
computed to exceed the 310 ppb threshold (Figure 1-16) at locations typically
beneath the surface slick, with maximum values ranging typically between 10
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

19

ppb to 1000 ppb (Figure 1-16). Over the entire duration of the model
simulation, and through all depths, 120 km of surface area exceeded the
threshold at some point in time.
The mass balance analysis (Figure 1-17) shows the shoreline oiling began after
33 hours until ultimately 23% of the mass was stranded on shore. The amount
of oil evaporated or volatilized into the atmosphere rose steadily to 18% after
18 days. Dissolved oil reached a maximum of 26% of the total mass. Surface
oil mass accounted for 7% to 8% of the total mass before ultimately
transferring to the shoreline. The remaining mass adsorbs to suspended
solids and sinks to the sediments.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

20

Figure 1-13

Scenario 1-2 trajectory and shoreline oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

21

Figure 1-14

Scenario 1-2 significant surface oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

22

Figure 1-15 Scenario 1-2 travel time (for significant oiling)


ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

23

Figure 1-16 Scenario 1-2 maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations


ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

24

Scenario 1-2 Mass Balance


100
Surface
Atmosphere
Dissolved
Shoreline
Entrained

90
80
% of Total Mass

70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0

24

48

72

96

120

144

168

192

216

240

264

288

312

336

360

384

408

432

456

Hours from Release

Figure 1-17 Scenario 1-2 mass balance

1.4.3

Scenario 1-3 October (Typical Winds), 5 day release, 8000 m/d


Scenario 1-3 is identical to Scenario 1-1 except the wind and current data are
for October instead of March. The currents provided by the US Navy were
radically different in October compared to March, because the October
currents were predominantly directed towards the south. In this scenario, no
shoreline was impacted until 78 hours after the initial release (Figure 1-18).
The oil traveled south covering 1958 km (Figure 1-19) after 18 days (Figure
1-20). Karampuang Island was not hit, though only by a near-miss. The travel
time plot shows the oil generally moved from the west to the east as it
traveled southward past Sulawesi. The maximum dissolved aromatic
concentration typically ranged between 1 ppb and 1000 ppb under the surface
slick trajectory from the release location towards West Sulawesi (Figure 1-21).
Over the entire duration of the model simulation, and through all depths, 46
km of surface area exceeded the 310 ppb threshold at some point in time. The
mass balance plot (Figure 1-22) shows the various forms of the oil stabilized
after the 5-day release to fairly constant values after 2-weeks: 33% on the
surface, 13% in the atmosphere, 31% dissolved, 2% on the shore and a
negligible amount entrained.
The remaining mass adsorbs to suspended solids and sinks to the sediments.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

25

Figure 1-18

Scenario 1-3 trajectory and shoreline oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

26

Figure 1-19

Scenario 1-3 significant surface oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

27

Figure 1-20

Scenario 1-3 travel time (for significant oiling)

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

28

Figure 1-21

Scenario 1-3 maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

29

Scenario 1-3 Mass Balance


100
Surface
Atmosphere
Dissolved
Shoreline
Entrained

% of Total Mass

80
60
40
20
0
0

24

48

72

96

120

144

168

192

216

240

264

288

312

336

360

384

408

432

456

-20
Hours from Release

Figure 1-22

1.4.4

Scenario 1-3 mass balance

Scenario 1-4 October (Maximum Winds), 5 day release, 8000 m/d


Scenario 1-4 was identical to Scenario 1-3 except the winds were held constant
at 11.2 m/s, blowing towards the east, at the maximum easterly wind speed
measured in October over all the 11 years of meteorological data (1999
through 2009). Though the currents dominated the overall direction of the
spill, the wind directed the surface oil towards the southeast, first contacting
shoreline 55 km away after 1 day (Figure 1-23). The oil remained at a
significant thickness throughout the time on the surface (Figure 1-24),
covering an area of 1447 km. The oil continued to contact some shorelines in
South Sulawesi and West Sulawesi, but mostly heading south away from
Sulawesis coast (Figure 1-25), leaving a total of 84km of shoreline oiled.
Though having several near-misses, Karampuang Island was not oiled.
However, under slightly different circumstances, oil could have contacted the
island. Maximum dissolved concentrations mostly ranged between 1 ppb and
1000 ppb (Figure 1-26). Over the entire duration of the model simulation, and
through all depths, 53 km of surface area exceeded the threshold at some
point in time.
The mass balance analysis (Figure 1-27) showed that after five days, the
amount of oil on the water surface peaks at 44% and decreased to 20%
remaining on the surface heading south past Sulawesi. At the end of the
model simulation, 8% of the total oil mass was stranded on the shoreline. The
remaining mass adsorbs to suspended solids and sinks to the sediments.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

30

Figure 1-23 Scenario 1-4 trajectory and shoreline oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

31

Figure 1-24 Scenario 1-4 significant surface oiling (for significant oiling)
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

32

Figure 1-25 Scenario 1-4 travel time


ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

33

Figure 1-26 Scenario 1-4 maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations


ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

34

Scenario 1-4 Mass Balance


100
Surface
Atmosphere
Dissolved
Shoreline
Entrained

90
80
% of Total Mass

70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0

24

48

72

96

120

144

168

192

216

240

264

288

312

336

360

384

408

432

456

Hours from Release

Figure 1-27

1.4.5

Scenario 1-4 mass balance

Scenario 2-1 March (Typical Winds), 112 day release, 3000 m/d
Scenario 2-1 was similar to Scenario 1-1 except it extended the release from 5
days to 112 days, with a rate of release decreased from 8000 m/d to 3000
m/d. Oil contacted 504 km of shoreline by the end of the model run (Figure
1-28) including Karampuang Island. The total area of water surface oiled with
a significant thickness was 1944 km (Figure 1-29). The oil first contacted
shore directly east of the release within 51 hours and continued oiling
shorelines there and to the south (Figure 1-30). The highest concentrations of
dissolved aromatics surrounded the shores of West Sulawesi, typically
ranging between 1 and 1000 ppb (Figure 1-31). Over the entire duration of the
model simulation, and through all depths, 20 km of surface area exceeded
the threshold at some point in time. The mass balance analysis (Figure 1-32)
showed that after the four month model simulation, 21% of the oil mass was
stranded on the shoreline, 40% was in the atmosphere, 27% had dissolved,
and 11% remained on the water surface without contacting shoreline.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

35

Figure 1-28

Scenario 2-1 trajectory and shoreline oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

36

Figure 1-29

Scenario 2-1 significant surface oiling (for significant oiling)

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

37

Figure 1-30

Scenario 2-1 travel time

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

38

Figure 1-31

Scenario 2-1 maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

39

Scenario 2-1 Mass Balance


100
Surface
Atmosphere
Dissolved
Shoreline
Entrained

90
80
% of Total Mass

70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0

500

1000

1500

2000

2500

3000

Hours from Release

Figure 1-32

1.4.6

Scenario 2-1 mass balance

Scenario 2-2 March (Maximum Winds), 112 day release, 3000 m/d
Scenario 2-2 was similar to Scenario 2-1 except it applied maximum winds
calculated from historical values for each month in the simulation period
(March through June). These values were 8.2 m/s (March), 9.4 m/s (April),
8.8 m/s (May), and 9.2 m/s (June). Ultimately, oil contacted 289 km of
shoreline after the 112-day release (Figure 1-33). The total area of water
surface oiled with a significant thickness was 1301 km (Figure 1-34),
including Karampuang Island. The oil mostly contacted shore directly east of
the release, first making contact within 34 hours, but also and to the south
after 19 days (Figure 1-35). The highest concentrations of dissolved aromatics
surrounded the shores of West Sulawesi, typically ranging between 1 and
1000 ppb (Figure 1-36). Over the entire duration of the model simulation, and
through all depths, 85 km of surface area exceeded the threshold at some
point in time.
The mass balance analysis (Figure 1-37) showed that after the four month
release, 25% of the oil mass was stranded on the shoreline once the remaining
mass on the water surface was stranded on shore. The 43% of the mass was
ultimately evaporated, and 31% was dissolved.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

40

Figure 1-33

Scenario 2-2 trajectory and shoreline oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

41

Figure 1-34

Scenario 2-2 significant surface oiling (for significant oiling)

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

42

Figure 1-35

Scenario 2-2 travel time

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

43

Figure 1-36

Scenario 2-2 maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

44

Scenario 2-2 Mass Balance


100
Surface
Atmosphere
Dissolved
Shoreline
Entrained

90
80
% of Total Mass

70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0

500

1000

1500

2000

2500

3000

Hours from Release

Figure 1-37

1.4.7

Scenario 2-2 mass balance

Scenario 2-3 October (Typical Winds), 112 day release, 3000 m/d
In Scenario 2-3 the surface oil first contacted the shorelines within 113 hours
after the initial release and ultimately contacted 277 km of shoreline
including Karampuang Island (Figure 1-38). A significantly thick oil layer
covered 1270 km of water surface through the 4-month release (Figure 1-39).
The oil traveled south but avoided the South Sulawesi shorelines until 25
days after the release (Figure 1-40). Dissolved concentrations typically ranged
from 1 to 1000 ppb with the greatest intensity between the Anoman Well and
the West Sulawesi coast (Figure 1-41). Over the entire duration of the model
simulation, and through all depths, 75 km of surface area exceeded the
threshold at some point in time. The mass balance analysis (Figure 1-42)
showed that ultimately after the 4-month simulation, 11% of the mass hit the
shoreline, while 16% on the surface continued to float south past Sulawesi. At
that time, 31% of the mass is dissolved and 41% evaporates into the
atmosphere.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

45

Figure 1-38

Scenario 2-3 trajectory and shoreline oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

46

Figure 1-39

Scenario 2-3 significant surface oiling (for significant oiling)

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

47

Figure 1-40

Scenario 2-3 travel time

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

48

Figure 1-41

Scenario 2-3 maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

49

Scenario 2-3 Mass Balance


100
Surface
Atmosphere
Dissolved
Shoreline
Entrained

90
80
% of Total Mass

70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0

500

1000

1500

2000

2500

3000

Hours from Release

Figure 1-42

1.4.8

Scenario 2-3 mass balance

Scenario 2-4 October (Maximum Winds), 112 day release, 3000 m/d
Scenario 2-4 was similar to Scenario 2-3 except it applied maximum winds
calculated from historical values for each month in the simulation period
(October through January). These values were 11.2 m/s (October), 7.6 m/s
(November), 11.2 m/s (December), and 9.2 m/s (January). Oil contacted 299
km of shoreline by the end of the model run (Figure 1-43). The total area of
water surface oiled with a significant thickness was 1157 km (Figure 1-44),
including Karampuang Island. The oil first contacted shore directly east of the
release within 44 hours, and oiled shoreline to the south after 4 days (Figure
1-45). The highest concentrations of dissolved aromatics surrounded the
shores of West Sulawesi, typically ranging between 1 and 1000 ppb (Figure
1-46). Over the entire duration of the model simulation, and through all
depths, 99 km of surface area exceeded the threshold at some point in time.
The mass balance analysis (Figure 1-47) showed that after the four month
release, 13% of the oil mass was stranded on the shoreline while 16% on the
surface continued to float south past Sulawesi. At the end of the simulation,
39% of the mass evaporated, and 31% was dissolved.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

50

Figure 1-43

Scenario 2-4 trajectory and shoreline oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

51

Figure 1-44

Scenario 2-4 significant surface oiling (for significant oiling)

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

52

Figure 1-45

Scenario 2-4 travel time

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

53

Figure 1-46

Scenario 2-4 maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

54

Scenario 2-4 Mass Balance


100
Surface
Atmosphere
Dissolved
Shoreline
Entrained

90
80
% of Total Mass

70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0

500

1000

1500

2000

2500

Hours from Release

Figure 1-47

1.4.9

Scenario 2-4 mass balance

Scenario 3-1 March (Typical Winds), 112 day release, 10800 m/d
Scenario 3-1 was identical to Scenario 2-1 except the release rate was
increased from 3000 m/d to 10800 m/d. The oil traveled in a similar manner
except oil covered more shoreline and more surface area on the water surface.
In this scenario, oil ultimately contacted 592 km of shoreline (Figure 1-48). A
significantly thick oil slick on the water surface covered 1943 km throughout
the 112 day release (Figure 1-49). The oil first contacted shore within 51 hours
and continued oiling the western coastal shorelines from north to south
(Figure 1-50). Maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations typically ranged
between 1 ppb to 1000 ppb, with a few small areas reaching over 10,000 ppb
(Figure 1-51). Over the entire duration of the model simulation, and through
all depths, 1,022 km of surface area exceeded the threshold at some point in
time. The mass balance analysis (Figure 1-52) showed that after the 112-days
of continuous release, shoreline oiling decreased from a maximum nearly
16% of the mass down to 5% by the end, mostly due to evaporative losses. Oil
transferred to the atmosphere steadily increased, and accounted for 52% of
the mass after 120 days. The remainder of the mass was either dissolved
(28%) or remained on the surface travelling south of Sulawesi (13%).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

55

3000

Figure 1-48 Scenario 3-1 trajectory and shoreline oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

56

Figure 1-49 Scenario 3-1 significant surface oiling (for significant oiling)
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

57

Figure 1-50 Scenario 3-1 travel time


ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

58

Figure 1-51 Scenario 3-1 maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations


ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

59

Scenario 3-1 Mass Balance


100
Surface
Atmosphere
Dissolved
Shoreline
Entrained

90
80
% of Total Mass

70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0

500

1000

1500

2000

2500

3000

Hours from Release

Figure 1-52 Scenario 3-1 mass balance

1.4.10

Scenario 3-2 March (Maximum Winds), 112 day release, 10800 m/d
Scenario 3-2 was identical to Scenario 2-2 except the release rate was
increased from 3000 m/d to 10800 m/d. The stronger wind influence
restricted the oil to a smaller water surface area and amount of shorelines
oiled than in Scenario 3-1, but the long duration of the spill limited the
differences between the two scenarios. In this scenario, oil ultimately
contacted 316 km of shoreline (Figure 1-53). A significantly thick oil slick on
the water surface covered 1342 km throughout the 112 day release (Figure
1-54). The oil first contacted shore within 415 hours and continued oiling the
western coastal shorelines of Sulawesi (Figure 1-55). Maximum dissolved
aromatic concentrations typically ranged between 1 ppb to 1000 ppb with a
few small areas reaching over 10,000 ppb (Figure 1-56). Over the entire
duration of the model simulation, and through all depths, 1,031 km of
surface area exceeded the threshold at some point in time, the highest of all
the simulations. The mass balance analysis (Figure 1-57) showed that after the
112-days of continuous release, 29% of the mass was dissolved. Shoreline
oiling decreased from a high of 14% of the mass down to 5% by the end,
mostly due to evaporative losses (29% of the mass). The remainder of the
mass remaining on the surface (9%) ultimately hit shoreline once the model
ended, raising the percentage on the shoreline up to 14% of the total mass.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

60

Figure 1-53 Scenario 3-2 trajectory and shoreline oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

61

Figure 1-54 Scenario 3-2 significant surface oiling (for significant oiling)
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

62

Figure 1-55 Scenario 3-2 travel time

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

63

Figure 1-56 Scenario 3-2 maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations


ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

64

Scenario 3-2 Mass Balance


100
Surface
Atmosphere
Dissolved
Shoreline
Entrained

90
80
% of Total Mass

70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0

500

1000

1500

2000

2500

3000

Hours from Release

Figure 1-57

1.4.11

Scenario 3-2 mass balance

Scenario 3-3 October (Typical Winds), 112 day release, 10800 m/d
Scenario 3-3 was identical to Scenario 2-3 except the release rate was
increased from 3000 m/d to 10800 m/d. The oil traveled in a similar manner
to Scenario 2-3, covering 9 km more shoreline (286 km in total) with more oil
mass and 110 km more surface area on the water surface (1380 km in total)
(Figure 1-58 and Figure 1-59). The oil first contacted shore within 108 hours
and continued oiling the western coastal shorelines from north to south
(Figure 1-60). Maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations typically ranged
between 1 ppb to 1000 ppb, with a few small areas reaching over 10,000 ppb
(Figure 1-61). Over the entire duration of the model simulation, and through
all depths, 622 km of surface area exceeded the threshold at some point in
time. The mass balance analysis (Figure 1-62) showed that after the 112-days
of continuous release, shoreline oiling decreased from a maximum nearly 7%
of the total mass down to 3% by the end of the release, mostly due to
evaporative losses and oil on the surface floating south past Sulawesi. Oil
transferred to the atmosphere steadily increased, and accounted for 43% of
the mass after 120 days. The remainder of the mass was either dissolved
(31%) or remained on the surface (22%).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

65

Figure 1-58 Scenario 3-3 trajectory and shoreline oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

66

Figure 1-59 Scenario 3-3 significant surface oiling (for significant oiling)
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

67

Figure 1-60 Scenario 3-3 travel time


ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

68

Figure 1-61 Scenario 3-3 maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations


ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

69

Scenario 3-3 Mass Balance


100
Surface
Atmosphere
Dissolved
Shoreline
Entrained

90
80
% of Total Mass

70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0

500

1000

1500

2000

2500

3000

Hours from Release

Figure 1-62 Scenario 3-3 mass balance

1.4.12

Scenario 3-4 October (Maximum Winds), 112 day release, 10800 m/d
Scenario 3-4 was identical to Scenario 3-3 except the winds were held constant
at historic monthly maximum values as described in Section 1.4.8. The oil
traveled in a similar manner to Scenario 2-3, but was driven further onto the
land covering 73 km more shoreline (359 km in total) and 136 km less surface
area on the water surface (1244 km in total) (Figure 1-63 and Figure 1-64).
The oil first contacted shore within 54 hours and continued oiling the western
coastal shorelines from north to south (Figure 1-65). Maximum dissolved
aromatic concentrations typically ranged between 1 ppb to 1000 ppb, with a
few small areas reaching over 10,000 ppb (Figure 1-66). Over the entire
duration of the model simulation, and through all depths, 636 km of surface
area exceeded the threshold at some point in time. The mass balance analysis
(Figure 1-67) showed that after the 112-days of continuous release, shoreline
oiling decreased from a maximum over 15% of the total mass down to 5% by
the end of the release, mostly due to evaporative losses and oil on the surface
floating south past Sulawesi. Oil transferred to the atmosphere steadily
increased, and accounted for 45% of the mass after 120 days. The remainder
of the mass was either dissolved (32%) or remained on the surface (17%).

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

70

Figure 1-63 Scenario 3-4 trajectory and shoreline oiling

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

71

Figure 1-64 Scenario 3-4 significant surface oiling (for significant oiling)
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

72

Figure 1-65 Scenario 3-4 travel time


ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

73

Figure 1-66 Scenario 3-4 maximum dissolved aromatic concentrations


ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

74

Scenario 3-4 Mass Balance


100
Surface
Atmosphere
Dissolved
Shoreline
Entrained

90
80
% of Total Mass

70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0

500

1000

1500

2000

2500

Hours from Release

Figure 1-67 Scenario 3-4 mass balance

1.5

CONCLUSION
The simulations presented in this study represent low probability, high risk
situations relative to potential impacts to the environment. Though much of
the oil is predicted to evaporate, the simulations show components in the oil
will persist, remaining on the water surface at a significant thickness before
reaching shorelines in both the typical and maximum wind scenarios. This
residue may in fact clump together in patches rather than form a uniform
surface slick; thus the simulation should be interpreted as the general areas of
potential coverage where oil may be observed, not necessarily as the total
surface area of coverage.
A summary of each scenario is provided in Table 1-5. Shoreline oiling is
predicted to occur between one to five days from release. Shoreline oiling
occurs on the coast of West Sulawesi first, and in most cases can occur to a
lesser extent later along the South Sulawesi coast. The amount of shoreline
oiled ranged from 36 km (Scenario 1-3) to 592 km (Scenario 3-1). The
shorelines oiled in the four Scenario 1 simulations after 5-days of oil releases
were at similar locations compared to the shorelines oiled during the 112-day
release scenarios, but the total length of shorelines oiled and the amount of
mass deposited on those shorelines are much greater in the 112-day release
scenarios. The longer the duration of the release, the greater the likelihood of
oil reaching coastline in South Sulawesi. However, regardless of the duration,
the majority of the significant surface oiling mass is concentrated off the coast
of West Sulawesi. Karampuang Island was determined to be at high risk for
shoreline impacts in all scenarios except Scenario 1-3 and Scenario 1-4;
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

75

3000

however, even in these two near-miss cases, the island could have been hit
under slightly different conditions.
The differences between the typical and the maximum wind scenarios are
evident in the location of shoreline contact, amount of oil on the surface, and
the time to reach the shoreline. Under constant maximum westerly wind
conditions, the time for oiled shorelines was reduced, most especially in
March (taking 26 hours, the shortest time to contact shoreline, in Scenario 13). The longest time to contract shoreline occurred in October under typical
wind conditions (113 hours in Scenario 2-3). The amount of oil on the water
surface is generally reduced in the maximum wind scenarios due to westerly
wind forcing the oil onto shorelines. For example, the smallest amount of
surface oiling, 1,013 km, occurred in Scenario 1-2 compared to 1,702 km
oiled under typical winds in Scenario 1-1. The greatest amount of surface
oiling occurred in Scenario 3-1 (1,944 km).
Table 1-5 Summary of model results
Scenario

Release

Month

Winds

Oiled
Shore
(km)

Time to
Contact
Shore (hrs)

1-1

8000 m/d
5 days
8000 m/d
5 days
8000 m/d
5 days
8000 m/d
5 days
3000 m/d
112 days
3000 m/d
112 days
3000 m/d
112 days
3000 m/d
112 days
10800 m/d
112 days
10800 m/d
112 days
10800 m/d
112 days
10800 m/d
112 days

March

Typical

171

41

Surface
Area
Oiled
(km)
1703

March

Maximum

93

33

1013

October

Typical

36

78

1958

October

Maximum

84

26

1447

March

Typical

504

51

1478

March

Maximum

289

34

1301

October

Typical

277

113

1270

October

Maximum

299

44

1157

March

Typical

592

51

1944

March

Maximum

316

108

1342

October

Typical

286

106

1380

October

Maximum

359

54

1244

1-2
1-3
1-4
2-1
2-2
2-3
2-4
3-1
3-2
3-3
3-4

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

76

Table 1-6 Summary of dissolved aromatics compared to the toxic threshold


Scenario
1-1

Maximum Area with Dissolved Aromatics


Above Threshold (km)
161

1-2

120

1-3

46

1-4

53

2-1

20

2-2

85

2-3

75

2-4

99

3-1

1022

3-2

1031

3-3

622

3-4

636

Dissolved concentrations of hydrocarbons, in particular the soluble aromatics,


are the components of oil typically of concern to the aquatic biota in the water
column during oil spills. A toxic threshold for aromatics was calculated to be
310 ppb, derived from 96-hour LC50 values. In all scenarios, the maximum
water column aromatic concentrations at times exceeded this threshold,
indicating a risk of water column injury to aquatic biota. However, this risk is
mitigated by the ability of fish to avoid the toxic plume at the water surface
where the concentrations are most likely to be highest. As a result, though
pelagic species are at risk, benthic organisms are unlikely to be impacted by
dissolved aromatics released by such spills. Variations of the amount of
water, in terms of the maximum surface area of water which exceeded the
aromatic toxic threshold at any time and depth during the model simulation,
are summarized in Table 1-6. The scenarios with the largest release rate in
March (Scenario 3-1 and Scenario 3-2) produced the largest dissolved
aromatic concentrations. The smallest of the maximum concentrations areas
(20 km) was calculated in Scenario 2-1. By comparison, in Scenario 2-2, the
area was slightly higher indicating the maximum winds caused greater
spreading of the most concentrated subsurface plume.
Environmental impacts due to a spill are primarily a concern to biota making
contact with the surface oiling and to wildlife contacting oil on an impacted
shoreline. An accidental release of oil is a much higher risk to birds and
wildlife contacting the surface oil than to fish and other organisms in the
water column. Vapors released during a spill may pose a human health risk
to workers in the vicinity of the well.
Impacts from oil released from an annulus blowout pose a medium to high
risk of impacts to organisms which contact the surface oil, depending on the
quantity released and time before any potential response efforts can contain
the release. Spills of this nature pose a low risk of acute toxic effects to the
aquatic biota. Several shorelines are at risk within the first few days after a
release.
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

77

DRILL CUTTING MODELING

2.1

SIMULATION DESIGN
Modeling was performed to assess potential environmental impacts due to
the release of drilling mud and drill cuttings during the planned operations.
The objectives of the drill cuttings modeling study were to determine whether
the disposal of the drill cuttings at the Anoman Well location will result in
unacceptable adverse impacts to any sensitive ecosystems. It should be noted
that this study has been limited to the examination of potential sedimentation
and total suspended sediment loads on coral habitats. It does not consider
impacts of drilling waste discharges on benthic and pelagic ecosystems, such
as smothering, toxicity (e.g. associated with the type of drilling fluid used) or
bioaccumulation of contaminants within the marine food chain. No specific
locations of coral habitats have been identified for this analysis.
The potential dispersion and deposition of released drill cuttings and adhered
muds has been quantified using hydrodynamic computer modeling
techniques. Modeling allows the prediction and description of the water
level, current velocity and direction in offshore Sulawesi waters, specifically
around the Anoman Well using the same hydrodynamic techniques and same
model grid employed in the oil spill modeling. Released material will pass
vertically through the water column, since cuttings and adhered muds are
denser than the receiving water; cuttings / mud plume dispersion is
fundamentally a 3-D phenomenon.
Two scenarios were evaluated: March and October. Unlike with oil spill
modeling, the extreme wind scenarios were not run since wind velocity has
exponentially diminishing influence on current velocity with depth.
Therefore, when running the model for the deep waters around the Anoman
Well, maximum wind scenarios would produce negligible differences
compared to the typical wind scenarios.
Discharge information was provided by StatOil. Both water based muds
(WBM) and synthetic based muds (SBM) are planned to be used by StatOil.
WBM used to drill sections prior to installing the riser will be released to the
seabed together with the cuttings and associated pumped seawater. All SBM
will be reused and stored at the Petrosea base when not in use. The cuttings
drilled from all sections with SBM will be dried in a separate cuttings dryer
system, crushed, and discharged to sea via the splash zone level in the moon
pool (i.e., sea surface) on the drill ship.
Estimated properties of the mud discharged are provided in Table 2-1. The
WBM is associated with the top hole drilling when cuttings are released to the
sea floor. Since the model terminates when all particles reach the sea floor,
simulating top hole drilling would cause the model to immediately end upon

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

78

running, and was therefore not included in the simulations. Cuttings are
estimated to dump at a rate of 480 m cuttings per well or 860 MT/well with
an estimated average density of 1.8 kg/L. The higher rate, 860 MT/well was
conservatively assumed for the modeling. Modeling was performed for the
first two sections of SBM drilling (20 open hole diameter for 10 days and
17.5 open hole diameter for 11 days) since subsequent sections released less
SBM; thus, the model was run assuming the first 21 days would present the
worst case of the entire period of drilling. Mud density varied with drilling
section. The average density (1.275 kg/L) of the two sections was assumed.
Table 2-1 Estimated mud discharge characteristics
36

Open Hole Diameter


(in)
Mud
Usage/Discharge
(m)
Mud
Usage/Discharge
(bbl)

24

20

17.5

13.25

Water base
mud

12.25

8.5

Plug &
Abandon

Synthetic base mud

328

3502

213

303

230

161

88

55

3950

1761

20264

1340

1906

1447

1013

553

346

Table 2-2 Estimated mud density and release rate

Total days

Section 3
20.0 diameter
10

Section 4
17.5 diameter
21

Days per section

10

11

Fluid type

SBM

SBM

Mud density (kg/L)

1.25

1.3

Mud usage/discharge (m)

213

303

Mud usage/discharge (L)

213000

303000

Mud mass discharged (kg)

266250

393900

Mud mass discharged (MT)

266.25

393.9

Mud mass discharge rate (MT/hr)

1.109

0.782

In the absence of site specific measured values, the particle size distribution of
the SBM and cuttings were assumed, based on previous drill cutting studies.
SBM particle sizes were assumed to be 40% 0 - 1500 m, 40% 1500 - 2500 m,
and 20% 2500 - 5000 m. These ranges were described as discrete Table 0-3.
Drill cuttings sizes were assumed to be in the range between 200 m and
8000 m. From distribution patterns seen in previous studies, the majority of
the particles sizes (80%) were assumed to be at the average value (4100 m),
while the maximum and minimum values of the range were assumed to be
each 10% of the particles (Table 2-4).
Table 2-3 Assumed SBM particle
Diameter (m)
200
4100
8000

% of cuttings
10%
80%
10%

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

79

Table 2-4 Assumed drill cuttings particle sizes.


Diameter (m)
750
1500
2000
2500
3750
5000

2.2

% of SBM
20%
20%
20%
20%
10%
10%

MODEL SELECTION
The simulation model used for this analysis is GEMSS, coupled with the
Generalized Integrated Fate & Transport (GIFT) module which incorporates
the GEMSS Sediment Transport Model (STM). For this application, the GIFT
model was used to compute the mass of sediment released for various
particle sizes and densities. The GIFT model, through a Lagrangian
framework, calculates the movement of particles representing the released
mass using the measured currents spread across each grid cell in the model
domain. The discharged drill cuttings and muds are modeled to predict the
total suspended solids in the water column and the net deposition.
Deposition and total suspended solids (TSS) estimates are thus designed to be
additions to ambient conditions.

2.3

ASSESSMENT CRITERIA
The potential for drill cuttings and adhered muds to impact coral colonies has
been assessed through a comparison with two criteria: sediment deposition
rate and concentrations of total suspended solids (TSS) above ambient.
Acceptable levels of each of these criteria have been based on international
literature and previously applied standards.
Hard or hermatypic corals are dependent upon symbiotic photosynthesizing
zooxanthellae for their survival and are, therefore, highly sensitive to
increases in suspended sediment and the corresponding reduction in light
penetration. Elevated levels of suspended sediments can also clog the corals
respiratory and feeding apparatus. In addition to impacts of suspended solids
in water, corals are susceptible to increased rates of deposition.
Species sensitivities to sedimentation are determined largely by the particle
trapping properties of the colony and ability of individual polyps to reject
settled materials. Horizontal plate-like colonies and massive growth forms
present large stable surfaces for the interception and retention of settling
solids. Conversely, vertical plates and upright branching forms are less likely
to retain sediments. Tall polyps and convex colonies are also less susceptible
to sediment accumulation than other growth forms. It is also acknowledged

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

80

that sensitivities to sediment loads can also vary markedly between species
within the same genus (Hawker and Connell, 1992).
The work of Pastorok and Bilyard (Pastorok and Bilyard, 1985) has been
regarded as the primary source for quantifying the effects of sedimentation
on corals, examining open water reefal environments where natural levels of
sedimentation are very low. Pastorok and Bilyard have suggested the
following criteria:

1 - 10 mg cm-2 day-1 - slight to moderate impacts

10 - 50 mg cm-2 day-1 - moderate to severe

50 mg cm-2 day-1 - severe to catastrophic

As corals can tolerate temporary changes in their local environment, it has


been assumed to take the moderate tolerance threshold of 10 mg cm-2 day-1
has been assumed for the purposes of this assessment.
Information on hard coral tolerances to TSS indicates that a 20% reduction in
annual growth rate corresponds to a 30% increase in average long-term
background TSS levels (Hawker and Connell, 1992). Background levels vary
from region to region and are site specific. It is known from research on the
Great Barrier Reef that corals can be prone to episodes of sedimentation from
a variety of sources, such as terrestrial run-off (Mapstone, et al., 1989). These
sediments are often re-suspended during and following wind and wave
action, resulting in low light levels due to turbidity. As such, elevations in
TSS levels above 50 mg/L have been considered as having the potential to
affect the physiology of corals. However, in Indonesia, in accordance with
MoE Regulation No 51 Year 2004 concerning sea water standard, the
threshold limits for TSS are as follows:

Coral reef : 20 mg/L with tolerable change <10%

Sea grass: 20 mg/L

Mangrove: 80 mg/L

Based on the above, the following set of Coral Tolerance Threshold Criteria
has been taken for the current assessment:

Criterion 1 - The maximum allowable sedimentation rate of sediment on


coral colonies should be no greater than 10 mg cm-2 day-1; and;

Criterion 2 - The maximum allowable increase in total suspended solids


at the bed layer of the water column in areas supporting coral colonies
should be no greater than 20 mg/L above ambient.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

81

2.4

RESULTS
The results of the modeling are illustrated in the following sections for each
scenario as contour plots. The plots presented indicate the location of the drill
cuttings release point, taken as the drill centre. The results have been
presented for comparison against the two criteria: net sedimentation rate
measured in mg cm-2 day-1 and TSS measured in mg/L. For each scenario,
the model output has been generated for the maximum TSS increase above
ambient solids concentrations.

2.4.1

Scenario 1 March currents and winds


For the first criterion in Scenario 1, drill cuttings in March yielded very small
sedimentation rates, orders of magnitudes below ranges of concern for
impacts associated with smothering from excessive sediment loads. The
highest rate calculated was 0.0097 mg cm-2 day-1. Figure 2-1 shows the
sedimentation rate for March after 12 days of accumulation when all particles
have settled; the net sedimentation rate would begin to decrease after that
time. The second criterion, TSS concentrations (Figure 2-2) briefly exceeded 20
mg/L, but only near the surface. TSS concentrations added to the bottom
layers never exceeded 1 ppb. Since the TSS criterion applied to solids
contacting coral, which would not be the case at the surface layers, the
criterion was not violated. Therefore, cuttings and muds pose low risk for
impacts due to sedimentation rate and TSS concentration.

2.4.2

Scenario 2 October currents and winds


Like Scenario 1, Scenario 2 yielded low sedimentation rates (reaching a
maximum of 0.011 mg cm day-1), orders of magnitude below values of
concern (Figure 2-3), satisfying the first criterion. For the second criterion, TSS
concentrations also resembled March values, with the maximum
concentration (66 mg/L) above the 20 mg/L criteria but at the surface above
the Anoman well, away from contact with coral. At the bottom model layers,
TSS concentrations did not exceed 1 mg/L. The mud and drill cuttings
therefore pose low risk for environmental impacts.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

82

Figure 2-1 Sedimentation rate - March currents and winds

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

83

Figure 2-2 Highest TSS concentrations added to background March currents and winds

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

84

Figure 2-3 Sedimentation rate - October currents and winds

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

85

Figure 2-4 Highest TSS concentrations added to background October currents and winds

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

86

2.5

CONCLUSIONS
Results from the drill cutting and mud modeling were compared against two
criteria: sediment deposition rate and TSS concentration.
The drill cuttings and adhered muds would spread from the drill centre
travelling 30 km to 40 km before reaching the sea floor. Note that a low but
reasonable dispersion coefficient was assumed such that the sedimentation
rate and suspended solids concentrations are considered realistic estimates.
Drilling waste disposal would result in compliance with the coral tolerance
threshold criterion of 10 mg cm-2 day-1. Sedimentation rates were estimated to
be orders of magnitude below the criterion and protective of sensitive coral
receptors.
The only TSS concentrations which exceed the 20 mg/L threshold criterion
occurred at the surface layers. Concentrations of TSS added to the bottom
layers from discharge of drill cuttings were all less than 1 mg/L. As such, TSS
concentrations were predicted to comply with the threshold criterion at all
coral sensitive areas in all scenarios.
Uncertainties in the mud and drill cutting particle size distributions and
densities are unlikely to affect the conclusions of this modeling study
considering the conservative estimates used; particle sizes are likely to be in
fact smaller than the assumed diameters, and thus have a higher
distribution pattern with less potential impact.
Overall, the modelling indicates that no impact on corals should occur at any
coral sensitive receptors that might exist in the area based upon the predicted
absence of exceedances of the two criteria.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

A1-87

REFERENCES
ANZECC & ARMCANZ. 2000. Australian and New Zealand guidelines
for fresh and marine water quality. October 2000. National Water
Quality Management Strategy Paper No. 4, Australian and New
Zealand Environment and Conservation Council & Agriculture
and Resource Management Council of Australia and New
Zealand, Canberra, Australia.
French, D., H. Schuttenberg, and T. Isaji. 1999. Probabilities of oil
exceeding thresholds of concern: examples from an evaluation for
Florida Power and Light. In Proceedings of the 22nd Arctic and
Marine Oil Spill Program (AMOP) Technical Seminar, June 1999,
Environment Canada, pp. 243-270.
French, D.P. 2000. Estimation of Oil Toxicity Using an Additive Toxicity
Model. In Proceedings, 23rd Arctic and Marine Oil Spill Program
(AMOP) Technical Seminar, June 14-16, 2000, Vancouver, Canada,
Emergencies Science Division, Environment Canada, Ottowa, ON,
Canada.
Hawker DW & Connell DW. 1992. Standards and Criteria for Pollution
Control in Coral Reef Areas. Chapter 7 of Pollution in Tropical
Aquatic Systems. Connell DW & Hawler DW ed. CRC Press.
Kolluru, V.S., M. L. Spaulding and E. Anderson. 1994. A Three
Dimensional Subsurface Oil Dispersion Model using a Particle
Based Approach. In Proceedings of the 17th Arctic and Marine Oil
Spill Program (AMOP) Technical Seminar, Vancouver, British
Columbia, Canada. pp. 867 - 894.
Koops, W. 1985. "The Oil Spill Slide Rule to Predict the Fate of an Oil
Spill." in: Proceedings of the 1985 International Oil Spill
Conference (Prevention, Behavior, Control, Cleanup), February
25-28, 1985, Los Angeles, CA. Washington, DC: American
Petroleum Institute, Publication 4385.647.
Mapstone BD, Choat JH, Cumming RL and Oxley WG. 1989. The
fringing reefs of magnetic island: benthic biota and sedimentation
- a baseline study. A report to the Great Barrier Reef Marine Park
Authority
Nilsen, H., G. H.G. Johnsen, T. Nordtug, . Johansen. 2006. Threshold
values and exposure to risk functions for oil components in the
water column to be used for risk assessment of acute discharges
(EIF Acute). Statoil and SINTEF report, C. FOU.DE.B02, 2006-0615.
NOAA. 1996. Aerial Observations of Oil at Sea. HAZMAT Report 96-7

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

A1-88

NOAA. 2009. GEODAS Grid Translator Design-a-Grid. NOAA


Satellite and Information Service. National Geophysical Data
Center (NGDC). Accessed October 26, 2009.
URL:
http://www.ngdc.noaa.gov/mgg/gdas/gd_designagrid.html?d
base=grdet1
Pastorok R.A. and Bilyard G.R. 1985. Effects of sewage pollution on
coral-reef communities. Marine Ecology Progress Series 21: 175189.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 1

A1-89

APPENDIX 2
ANALYTICAL RESULT OF SEAWATER QUALITY

Water Column Sampling


The water column samples were done to determine Waters physical,
chemical as well as biological parameters are important to examine the
quality of the surrounding environmental. Most of the parameters has been
done analysis in laboratory. The water column sampling technique was
required to maintain the real quality and environmental condition of the
samples. Water samples were stored in a certain environment and then were
been analysis in the laboratory with proper techniques.
Water samples has been taken using a 5 liters water sampler (Niskin type)
each desire layer and location. Volumes sampled for all parameters good
enough for analysis each parameter client requirement. Glass bottles have
been used for hydrocarbon analysis, suspended matter and nutrient analysis,
and plastic bottles for nitrogen and heavy metals.
(Chlorophyll) are gathered immediately by filtering the water samples, are
gathered immediately by filtering (0.45m) water samples. The filters are
then frozen for conveyance to the laboratory. Samples pre-treatments/
reservations and done carried out according to the standard
methodology/procedure and kept in cool conditions (-4C).
The water sample were taken and divided to 5 layers from sea water surface
to near bottom as follows:

Location
1b
2
4

Water Depth in Meter


Surface
10
10
10

Surface
Middle
400
400

Middle
620
700

Middle
Bottom
1200
1300

Bottom
1650
1830
130

The Water Column bellows were been done analysis in laboratories:


A. Physical
Light Intensity
Odor
Turbidity
Total Suspended Solid
Floating object
Oil Layer
B. Chemical
pH
Salinity
DO
BOD5
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 2

A2-1

Total Ammonia (NH3-N)


Phosphate (PO4-P)
Nitrate (NO3-N)
Cyanide (CN)
Sulfide (H2S)
PAH (Polycylic Aromatic Hydrocarbon)
Total Phenol
PCB
PCB Total
Biphenyl Surfactant
Oil and Grease
Pesticide
TBT

C. Heavy metal :

Mercury (Hg)
Chromium hexavalent (Cr(VI))
Arsenic (As)
Cadmium (Cd)
Copper (Cu)
Lead (Pb)
Zinc (Zn)
Nickel (Ni)
Barium (Ba)
Selenium (Se)

D. Biology :
Coliform
Pathogen
Plankton (Chlorophyll a)
E. Radioactivity:

226Ra, 228Ra, 210Pb

F. Additional Parameter
CO2
Total organic carbon (TOC)
Total Hydro carbon (THC)
Silicate
C:N:P ratio
Heavy Metal : Al, Fe,V

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 2

A2-2

G. List of PAH16
Acenaphthene
Acenaphthylene
Anthracene
Benzo (a) anthracene
Benzo (a) pyrene
Benzo (b) fluoranthene
Benzo (ghi) perylene
Benzo (k) fluoranthene
Chrysene
Dibenzo (a, h) anthracene

Fluoranthene
Fluorene
Indeno (1,2,3-cd) pyrene
Naphthalene
Phenanthrene
Pyrene

Method of analysis for the Examination of Water and Wastewater (SMEWW),


International Standard (ISO) or Indonesian National Standard (SNI) has been
used as standard on the laboratory analysis for the water quality parameters.
Table below shows the methods were used for the determination of each
parameter.
No
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28

Analyzed Parameter
Turbidity
Total Suspended Solid
pH
Salinity
Temperature
Conductivity
Dissolved Oxygen (DO)
Ammonia (NH3-N)
Ortho Phosphate (PO4)
Nitrate (NO3-N)
Cyanide (CN)
Sulphide (H2S)
Polycyclic Aromatic Hydrocarbon (PAH)
Total Phenol
PCB
PCB Total
Pesticide
Mercury (Hg)
Hexavalent Chromium (Cr(VI))
Arsenic (As)
Cadmium (Cd)
Cooper (Cu)
Lead (Pb)
Zinc (Zn)
Total Coliform Bacteria / 100 ml sample
CO2
Aluminium (Al)
Iron (Fe)

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

Analysis Method
SMEWW-2130-B
SMEWW 2540-D
SMEWW-4500-H+-B
SMEWW 2520
SMEWW-2550
SMEWW-2510
SMEWW 4500-O-G
SMEWW-4500-NH3-F
SMEWW 4500-P-D
SNI 06-2480 1991
SMEWW 4500-CN C
SMEWW 4500-S2 H
ISO28540
SNI 06-2469-1991
SNI 06-2508-1991
SNI 06-2508-1991
SNI 06-2508-1991
SMEWW 3500-Hg
SMEWW 3500 Cr D
SMEWW 3500B-As
SMEWW 3500-Cd
SMEWW 3500-Cu
SMEWW 3500-Pb
SMEWW-3500-Zn
SMEWW 9216
SMEWW-4500-CO2
SMEWW 3500-Al
SMEWW-3500-Fe-B

STATOIL
APPENDIX 2

A2-3

Appendix 2: Analytical Result of Seawater Quality


Parameters
a. Physical
Light density
Odor
Turbidity
Total Suspended
Solids (TSS)
Floating object

Units

b. Chemical
pH
Salinity
Dissolved Oxygen
BOD 5 days
Ammonia Nitrogen
(NH3-N)
Phosphate (PO4-P)
Nitrate (NO3-N)
Cyanide (CN)
Sulphide (H2S)
Total phenol
Surfactant (MBAS)
Oil and grease
CO2
Total Organic
Carbon (TOC)

Locations

Marine
Biota

1B-a

1B-b

1B-c1

1B-c2

1B-d

1B-e

2-a

2-b

2-c1

2-c2

2-d

2-e

4-a

4-b

meter

5
natural

>20
no odor

no odor

no odor
2.7
<1

no
odor
1.5
<1

no
odor
1.9
<1

no
odor
2.1
<1

no odor

2.4
<1

no
odor
1.8
<1

>20
no odor

1
<1

no
odor
2.3
<1

no odor

<5
80

no
odor
2.9
<1

>20
no odor

NTU
mg/L

no
odor
2.7
<1

1.2
<1

3
<1

2.1
<1

no floating
object
no oil
layer

no flying
object
no oil layer

28.8

10.7

10.9

10.8

8.1

11.5

9.8

10.2

7.3

7.2

no flying
object
no oil
layer
29.6

no flying
object
no oil
layer
29

21.8

mg/L
mg/L
mg/l-N

7-8.5
natural
>5
20
0.3

8.25
32.23
4
18.2
0.086

8.28
33.73
3.7
17.6
0.015

8.32
33.63
3.5
20.8
0.004

8.34
33.72
3.6
18.4
0.017

8.25
34.2
3.6
18.8
<0.004

8.27
33.89
3.5
21.4
0.074

8.38
33.23
4.1
14.2
0.077

8.43
33.06
2.7
12.3
0.026

8.29
33.39
2.4
18.4
0.006

8.41
33.3
2.2
18.2
0.009

8.28
33.39
2.7
15.7
0.017

8.43
32.91
1.8
16.8
0.012

8.32
32.25
3.8
10.8
0.124

8.42
32.01
3.4
12.2
0.009

mg/l-P
mg/l-N

0.015
0.008

0.009
<0.007

0.047
0.452

0.05
0.404

0.066
0.357

0.069
0.413

0.071
0.533

0.022
<0.007

0.058
0.404

0.061
0.463

0.08
0.463

0.074
0.501

0.042
<0.007

0.016
0.044

mg/l
mg/l
mg/l
mg/l
mg/l
mg/l
mg/l

0.5
0.01
0.002
1
1
0.0

0.03
<0.02
<0.01
1.07
2.3
0.0
1.71

0.05
<0.02
<0.01
1.26
4.7
0.0
2.72

0.05
<0.02
<0.01
0.442
5.7
0.0
0.69

0.05
<0.02
<0.01
0.273
6
0.0
1.71

0.06
<0.02
<0.01
0.73
3.7
0.0
0.69

0.06
<0.02
<0.01
0.283
7
0.0
1.71

0.03
<0.02
0.015
0.366
5.6
0.0
0.69

0.04
<0.02
0.019
0.398
5.6
0.0
1.71

0.04
<0.02
0.019
0.334
4.2
0.0
3.74

0.014
<0.00
7
0.05
<0.02
<0.01
0.314
3.4
0.0
3.72

0.03
<0.02
<0.01
0.263
5.2
0.0
1.71

0.06
<0.02
<0.01
0.243
4
0.0
0.69

0.05
<0.02
0.019
0.293
2.2
0.0
1.71

0.06
<0.02
0.036
0.194
2.8
0.0
1.71

Oil layer
Temperature

MoE 512004

oC

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

1.2
<1

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

A2-4

Parameters

Units

MoE 512004

Marine
Biota

Locations

1B-a

1B-b

1B-c1

1B-c2

1B-d

1B-e

2-a

2-b

2-c1

2-c2

2-d

2-e

4-a

4-b

2.7
5.14
0.000
04
0.078
ND
ND
ND
0

2.4
<0.08
0.00006

0.4
2.82
0.000
5
<0.01
ND
ND
ND
0

1
4.65
0.0001

1.8
0.278
0.0003

2.4
0.278
0.0014

0.046
ND
ND
ND
0

2.8
5.9
0.002
3
0.015
ND
ND
ND
0

0.6
6.55
0.00001

0.035
ND
ND
ND
0

1.8
1.97
<0.00
1
0.078
ND
ND
ND
0

<0.01
ND
ND
ND
0

<0.01
ND
ND
ND
0

<0.01
ND
ND
ND
0

Total hydrocarbon
Silicate
C:N:P ratio

mg/l
mg/l

1.7
<0.08
<0.001

3
1.25
0.048

1
2.71
0.0003

2.7
4.06
0.0007

3
4.65
0.0001

Iron (Fe)
PAH
PCB
TBT
Organochlorin
pesticide
Carbamates
pesticide
Organophospates
pesticide
c. Heavy metals
Mercury (Hg)
Chromium
hexavalent (Cr VI)
Arsenic (As)
Cadmium (Cd)

mg/l
mg/l
mg/l
mg/l
ppb

0.035
ND
ND
ND
0

0.015
ND
ND
ND
0

0.015
ND
ND
ND
0

0.035
ND
ND
ND
0

0.01
ND
ND
ND
1.101
(*)
0

Copper (Cu)
Lead (Pb)
Zinc (Zn)
Nickel (Ni)
Barium (Ba)
Selenium (Se)
Aluminium (Al)
Vanadium (V)
d. Radioactivity
226 Ra

0.003
0.01
0.01

g/l
mg/l

1
0.005

1.18
0.01

0.027
0.023

<0.06
0.018

<0.06
0.02

0.046
0.015

0.09
0.009

<0.06
0.013

<0.06
0.028

0.09
0.008

0.18
0.009

<0.06
0.13

0.27
0.007

<0.06
0.035

0.18
0.018

mg/l
mg/l

0.012
0.001

0.009
0.0002

0.009
<0.0001

0.008
<0.0001

0.009
<0.0001

0.072
0.233
0.075
0.376
0.092
0.01
0.455
0.022

0.008
<0.00
01
0.071
0.288
0.076
0.324
0.012
0.012
0.316
0.024

0.007
<0.00
01
0.079
0.283
0.062
0.291
0.012
0.012
0.386
0.022

0.012
<0.0001

0.067
0.205
0.061
0.35
0.111
0.01
0.504
0.026

0.007
<0.00
01
0.074
0.28
0.064
0.378
0.009
0.009
0.472
0.023

0.008
0.0002

0.069
0.208
0.069
0.355
0.104
0.015
0.305
0.021

0.007
<0.00
01
0.069
0.272
0.073
0.328
0.015
0.015
0.567
0.024

0.01
<0.0001

0.008
0.008
0.05
0.05

0.009
<0.00
01
0.066
0.225
0.065
0.37
0.013
0.013
0.469
0.024

0.008
<0.0001

mg/l
mg/l
mg/l
mg/l
mg/l
mg/l
mg/l
mg/l

0.008
<0.00
01
0.072
0.194
0.073
0.0369
0.016
0.016
0.537
0.024

0.071
0.229
0.072
0.306
0.008
0.008
0.25
0.02

0.078
0.3
0.078
0.262
0.007
0.007
0.273
0.024

0.074
0.263
0.068
0.222
0.007
0.007
0.572
0.02

1.2 0.8

1.1 0.7

3.2 1.7

2.0
1.2

3.5
1.2

0.07
0.24
0.068
0.352
0.017
0.017
0.769
0.029

0.072
0.293
0.069
0.359
0.012
0.012
0.557
0.023

4,000
mBq/l

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

3.9
1.4

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

A2-5

Parameters

Units

MoE 512004

Marine
Biota

Locations

1B-a

1B-b

1B-c1

1B-c2

1B-d
1.9
0.7
< 200
200

1B-e

2-a

2-b

2-c1

2-c2

2-d

2-e

4-a

4-b

228 Ra

mBq/l

0.1 0.1

0.1 0.1

2.3 1.2

210 Pb

mBq/l

3,800
9,400

1,000
5,700

3,900
5,900

0.8
0.4
200
300

1000

93

240

23

93

23

43

75

no bloom

1.415
1.49
2.469
5.374

1.191
1.864
2.114
5.168

1.53
1.781
2.466
5.777

2.081
2.076
4.094
8.251

1.209
1.632
2.058
4.9

1.153
1.603
1.55
4.306

1.521
1.908
2.419
5.849

1.209
1.527
1.959
4.704

0.991
1.239
1.612
3.842

0.85
1.115
1.449
3.415

0.722
0.9
1.202
2.824

1.038
1.426
1.655
4.119

0.653
1.021
1.299
2.974

0.213
0.458
0.496
1.167

19,594

8,250

1,031

19,301

5,344

4,688

15,375

8,250

2.43

1.66

1.07

2.48

1.31

1.35

2.331

1.67

0.92
0.08

0.93
0.07

0.97
0.03

0.89
0.11

0.94
0.06

0.97
0.03

0.9
0.1

0.93
0.07

e. Biology
Total Coliform
Faecal Coliform
Chlorophyll-a
Chlorophyll-b
Chlorophyll-c
Total Chlorophyll
Phytoplankton and
Zooplankton
Individual total
number
Shannon-Wiener
Diversity Index
Evenness Index
Dominance Index

colony/1
00ml
colony/1
00ml
mg/l
mg/l
mg/l
mg/l

ind/l

3.0
1.1
200
200

MoE 51-2004: Minister of Environment Decree No. 51 of 2004 concerning Sea Water Quality, Appendix III-Marine Biota
ND:Not detected

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
EIA DRILLING

A2-6

APPENDIX 3
ANALYTICAL RESULT OF SEABED SEDIMENT
QUALITY

Sediment Samples
Sediment samples were conducted to provide an amount of sediment t for
physical chemical analyses. The rested samples have been processed for
benthos analyses. Some samples have been processed onboard for visual
analysis and some samples returned to shore for further analysis. Some
portions of the sediment analysis placed in a fridge to avoid any
contamination and good condition. The samples pre-treatments carried out
to the usually approved methodology (rules of the art) and kept in cool
conditions (-4C).
A. Gravity Core
Gravity Core samples has been taken in desire position used 400 kg weight
of core head with 4 meter barrel length PVC and head catcher were used to
collect samples for further analysis of geochemical and geotechnical Sample
were landed on deck and the plastic liner extruded from the core barrel.
The liner cut with a hacksaw into 50 cm sections working downward from
the seabed and sealed by plastic caps secured by insulating or duct tape. To
avoid any dispute for numbering and sequence of core barrel, marked Top
and bottom of barrel after completion of taking sample. The samples will be
returned to shore in this state without any analytical work being
undertaken

B. Grab Sampling
Grab samples were provided an amount of sediment to be taken for
physical chemical analyses and the rest of the sample separated for
benthos analyses. The core box with dimension 40 cm x 40 cm equal with
0.16 m2 was used to collect the sample at proposed location. The amount of
sample collected to ensure enough for geochemical and geotechnical
analysis. Visual analysis were been taken onboard and some rest data
collected and stored sealed container for benthos plankton analysis.
Listed below were analysis has been done in Laboratory:
a. Physico-chemical characteristics.
Parameters measured are:
Grain size distribution
Total Organic Carbon (TOC)
Nutrient (Ammonium, Nitrate, Phosphate)
C:N:P Ratio
O2
Sulfides
ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 3

A3-1

Total Hydrocarbons (THC)


Poly Aromatic Hydrocarbons (PAH)

B. Heavy metals : Al, Fe, Ba, Pb, Cr, Cu, Zn, Ni, Cd, Hg,V, As, Cobalt
(Co),Magnese (Mn), Mercury (Hg), Selanium (Se), Silver
(Ag)
C. Radioactivity : included at minimum 226Ra,228Ra,210Pb
D. Biology characteristics:

Name and Number of species (flora/fauna)


Number (abundance) of individual per species
Biomass per species
Distribution
The indexes to be calculated are: Shannon diversity index,
dominance index, evenness index

American Public Health Association American Water Works Association


(APHA AWWA) and American Public Health Association (APHA)
Standard Methods will be used as standard on the laboratory analysis to
analyze the biology sediment.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 3

A3-2

Appendix 3:

Analytical Result of Seabed Sediment


Location Point

Parameters

Units

1B

OSPAR
4

BC

EAC
Lower
Limit

EAC
Upper
Limit

a. Physico-Chemical Characteristics
Total
Organic
Carbon
Ammonium

36.5

27.76

Nitrate
Phosphate

mg/kg

mg/kg

11.88

14.46

16.43

mg/kg

<0.01

72.26

<0.01

3,738.26

3,087.41

2,902.83

97.9

286.39

191.62

mv

97

68

115

mg/kg

ND

ND

ND

mg/kg

279.74

259.9

239.94

mg/kg

ND

ND

ND

C:N:P ratio
Oxidation
Potential
Redox
(ORP)
Sulphide
Total
hydrocarbon
PAH

27.45

Aluminium
(Al)
Iron (Fe)

mg/kg

20,900

44,700

31,200

Mg/kg

2,400

3,800

1,800

Barium (Ba)

mg/kg

128.7

113.3

91.76

Lead (Pb)

mg/kg

19.64

26.86

23.12

Chromium
(Cr)
Copper (Cu)

mg/kg

17.83

23.45

19.54

mg/kg

33.99

35.45

28.94

Zinc (Zn)

mg/kg

75.24

62.49

Nickel (Ni)

mg/kg

44.38

Cadmium
(Cd)
Mercury
(Hg)
Vanadium
(V)
Arsenic (As)

mg/kg

0.176

25

50

60

50

20

50

66.17

90

10

100

48.05

46.94

30

50

0.237

0.206
0.2

0.1

0.05

0.05

0.05

15

10

mg/kg

0.54

0.38

0.3

mg/kg

67.65

87.71

79.4

mg/kg

2.31

9.5

7.06

Cobalt (Co)

mg/kg

19.63

24.67

22.41

Manganese
(Mn)
Selenium
(Se)
Silver (Ag)

mg/kg

180

220

900

mg/kg

18.7

24.3

20.8

mg/kg

8.39

8.87

6.58

b. Radioactivity
226 Ra

mBq/kg

1,150760

1,22089

1,09076

228 Ra

mBq/kg

65764

890120

1,180120

210 Pb

mBq/kg

<50,50042,000

<70,0007,2100

<28,50033,345

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 3

A3-3

c. Biology
Benthos
Individual
Total
Number
Shannon
diversity
index

Ind/m2

Evenness
Index
Dominance
Index

30,698

2,674

1.15

1.06

Low

Low

0.59

0.66

0.41

0.34

Note:
ND: Not Detected
Intermediate Shannon index = 1.650.57

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 3

A3-4

APPENDIX 4
STAKEHOLDER ENGAGEMENT MEETING REPORT

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 3

A3-5

Public Socialization Report


Oil and Gas Exploration Activity Plan in
Karama Block, Makassar Strait

December 2009
Proponent:

Statoil Indonesia Karama AS

Delivering sustainable solutions in a more competitive world

TABLE OF CONTENTS
TABLE OF CONTENTS ..........................................................................................I
1

INTRODUCTION......................................................................................... 1

1.1

BACKGROUND .................................................................................................. 1

1.2

PURPOSE AND OBJECTIVE ................................................................................ 1

IMPLEMENTATION OF PUBLIC SOCIALIZATION .......................... 3

2.1

DATE ................................................................................................................. 3

2.2

PLACE................................................................................................................ 3

2.3

PARTICIPANTS .................................................................................................. 3

OUTCOME FROM THE PUBLIC SOCIALIZATION ........................... 4

CONCLUSION .............................................................................................. 5

3.1

QUESTION ....................................................................................................... 13

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 4

INTRODUCTION

1.1

BACKGROUND
Statoil Indonesia Karama AS (Statoil) plans to conduct exploration drilling
activities in Karama Block, Makassar Straits in Mamuju Regency West
Sulawesi Province in 2011.
In 2006 Statoil has signed an MOU with Pertamina and in 2007 Statoil and
Pertamina secured a Production Sharing Contractor (PSC) for the Karama
Block.
In order to support the implementation of oil and gas exploration activities in
the Karama Block, Statoil conducted public socializing as part of the internal
Environmental Impact Assessment Study. Public socialization activities were
implemented as one of the efforts in disseminating information about the
plan of oil and gas exploration drilling activities which will take place in the
area.
Statoil conducted the public socialization in coordination with BP Migas
Kalsul representative office and West Sulawesi Province Energy and Mineral
Office. The public socialization also attended by the stakeholders
Until now, Statoil has conducted several studies which are part of internal
requirement, namely:

1.2

Stakeholder mapping

EMPs of 3D siesmic survey

Study area and national regional profiles

Baseline study of water quality, sediment and aquatic biota

Oil spill modelling

Drilling cuttings distribution modelling

PURPOSE AND OBJECTIVE


In general, the purpose and objective of public socialization is to inform the
plan of oil and gas exploration activity and an explaination of the potential
environmental impact of the activity in Karama Block.
In particular, the public socialization is intended:
1) To gather suggestions, opinions, and responses concerning the oil and gas
exploration activity

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 4

2) To protect public interest sorounding the activity area from potential


impact that may arise from the project.
3) To establish an atmosphere of equal partnerhip bertween the parties
interest in oil and gas exploration activity in Karama Block.
4) To respect the right of all parties to obtain information relating to oil and
gas exploration activities in the Karama Block.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 4

IMPLEMENTATION OF PUBLIC SOCIALIZATION

2.1

DATE
The public socialization held on December 3, 2009 at the auditorium of Hotel
Anugrah, Mamuju, West Sulawesi.

2.2

PLACE
Public consultation is conducted in Mamuju which is the nearest city to the
project area. Mamuju was choosed because it is the capital city of West
Sulawesi Province and relatively accessible for the entire stakeholders.

2.3

PARTICIPANTS
The participants were members of Coordinator/Facilitator/Mediator of
Implementation of Oil and Gas Exploration/Exploitation of West Sulawesi
Province which consist of representative from related institution in West
Sulawesi Province. The public socialization also attended by media and
NGOs.
Details list of participants and documentation of the public socialization
event are presented in Appendix 1 and Appendix 3.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 3

OUTCOME FROM THE PUBLIC SOCIALIZATION


The public socialization is divided into three sessions, namely:

Session I-Opening
o

Greetings and project activity overview from Statoil presented by


Neisharsa Triaswari.

Message from Governor of West Sulawesi Province delivered by


Secretary of West Sulawesi Province and officialy open the public
socialization event.

Session II-Presentation
o

Project exposure of oil and gas activity presented by Ananda Idris


(Statoil Government and Public Affair Manager)

Environmental Impact Assessment overview by Yahya Husin (ERM


Indonesia), Team leader of EIA document preparation)

Session III-Discussion
o

Question and Answer Session between the proponent and the


participants is guided by Andi Yasin Head of Energy and Mineral
Office, West Sulawesi province , as moderator.

During the public socialization discussion session, the participants were


actively involved in providing critical inputs associated with the plan of oil
and gas exploration drilling in the area. The summary are as follows, while
transcript of the discussion session is presented in Appendix 2.

Employement for local people at Statoil activities.

Compansation for the rumpons owner located in the drilling site.

Changes in water quality caused by drilling cuttings and drilling mud


during drilling operation.

Disruption to fishing activity.

Operasion base which is planned to be located in Balikpapan instead of in


Mamuju.

More comprehensive socialization activities that involve communities in


the vicinity of the project location.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 3

CONCLUSION
Based on the results of the public socialization, and by looking at the issues
that arise, there are some key issues concerning oil and gas exploration
activity in Karama Block in Makassar Strait Mamajuju Regency West
Sulawesi Province that can be summarized as follows:
1) Water quality aspect related to drilling cutting and drilling mud
management.
2) Social and Economics aspect releted to job opportunity for local people,
community development program and compensation to rumpon owner
and fishing group affected by the activity.

ENVIRONMENTAL RESOURCES MANAGEMENT

STATOIL
APPENDIX 3

APPENDICES

Appendix 1

List of participants

APPENDIX 2

MINUTES OF PUBLIC SOCIALIZATION

Minutes of Public Socialization


Plan for Oil and Gas Exploration Activities in the Karama Block
Makassar Strait Mamuju Regency West Sulawesi Province
Mamuju, December 3, 2009

OPENING
A. Statoil Activity Report by Niesharsa Triaswari
B. Message from the Vice Governor of West Sulawesi Province,
represented by Secretary of West Sulawesi Province as well as
officially open the public socialization.
C. Prayer by Ikhwan Yaman

PRESENTATION
A.

Moderator : Drs. Andi Muh. Yasin, MSi (West Sulawesi ProvinceEnergy and Mineral Dept.)

Details of activiries: exploration, operations, seismic survey and


drilling.

Legislative context of oil and gas industries.

Exposure

a. Ananda Idris-Goverment & Public Affairs Manager Statoil Indonesia

Overview of oil and gas industries.

Statoil company profile introduction Statoil is leading company in


deep sea oil and gas exploration and operation.

Statoil has conducted seismic survey in Karama Block to gather


information on oil and gas reserve of the area.

Development and Operation strategy of a production unit will refer to


the result of seismic survey and exploration drilling.

b. Yahya Husin (PT. ERM Indonesia)

Explaination on environmental impact assessment study:

Statoil has conducted several studies in order to get information


and environmental baseline of the Karama Block in Mamuju, such
as stakeholder mapping, seismic survey and social study.

Based on the studies, there are some sensitive areas, among them
is mangrove ecosystem along the Mamuju shoreline.

In addition to sensitive areas, informations gathered from the


studies are usefull in determine the potential impact from drilling
activity.

Q-A SESSION I
Question
1. HEAD OF MAMUJU REGENCY ENVIRONMENTAL OFFICE - MULYADI

The seismic survey was conducted using microphone on the sea


surface, is there any other technology so that it will not interupted
the existed rumpon in the area.

Operational Base is expected to be in Mamuju, West Sulawesi,


instead of in Balikpapan, so that it will help to increase the local
economy of Mamuju.

Drilling activity can cause an environmental problem, for example


in Sidoardjo and Timor Sea, what is the base on impact criteria
determination so that drilling activity only requires UKL-UPL.

2. APPMI (ASSOCIATION OF COMMUNITY EMPOWERMENT)-IKHWAN BUSTAM

Regarding the community empowerment program, will it be


involving government or the culutral communities.

Area that will be impacted by the drilling activity.

Disposal procedures of drilling cuttings and safety of the


operation.

How long is the interval between exploration and production


process.

3. REPRESENTATIVE OF FISHERMEN GROUP

Clarification concerning compensation to fishermen, since


previously compensation was only given to rumpon owner.

4. WEST SULAWESI PROVINCE ENVIRONMENTAL OFFICE

Public socialization is expected to be conducted near the project


location.

Government supervision will refer to the approved document.

5. GERAK LAPAR NGO

What is the sharing system between government and the


company.

Job opportunity is expected to give priority to local worker.

EIA document preparation process.

Compensation to rumpon owner did not consider losses to the


communities, for example disturbance to shipping line.

RESPONSE
1. STATOIL- ANANDA IDRIS

Sharing system between the government and the companies that


appear in the presentation graph is not done in nominal terms, but
takes the form of conversion to the barrels of oil production
beyond the current oil price.

Time period of exploration to production can not be determined


directly prior to the drilling process because there are several steps
that need to be done to determine the amount of oil reserves and
economics feasibility, including drilling to determine the presence
or absence of oil and gas reserves. If the result is positive, the
drilling of appraisal well is conducted to determine the amount of
oil and gas reserves, based on that, the economics feasibility
studies is then carry out.

Development of production unit will be based on economics


feasibility studies result and also political judgment.

Seismic survey using microphone is conducted based on sound


reflection principle. Survey is conducted on sea surface based on
water characteristics as good sound conductor. If it is conducted
below the surface, the sound reflection will not maximum and the
result will not be accurate.

Sharing contract with the government refers to Oil and Gas Law in
2002 with the open possibility of such operation. Fundamental
change is the clause in the Domestic Market Obligation which
required operators to market some products to meet domestic
needs.

The availability of employment is related to the result of economic


and social feasibility study, this will be answered after a known
number of existing oil and gas reserves at the site could be
exploited.

Indemnity compensation has been set trough West Sulawesi


Governor Regulation. The company will follow the regulation.

Addition comment from the Head of Maritime and Fisheries


Office that the compensation issue of seismic activity has been
completed and no problem occurred during the implementation.
2. ERM- BAPAK YAHYA HUSIN

Explanation on determination of significant impact criterion and


studies that have been conducted.

In conducting an activity, there are studies that require approval


and studies that not require approval from the related institution.
Statoil as a company that will have an activity in Mamuju area has
conducted baseline studies that not require approval from any
institution. As for study that requires approval, it will be
conducted base on the guideline stipulated in government
regulations, for oil and gas operation, the approval will be issued
from Central Government level.

Minister of Environment Decree No. 11 year 2006 stated which


activity requires an AMDAL or UKL-UPL. As mention in the
Decree, Exploration drilling only requires UKL-UPL. Based on
several studies that have been conducted by Directorate General of
Oil and Gas to drilling activity in Indonesia, it is concluded that
drilling activity did not generate significant impact therefore the
activity only require UKL-UPL.

Stakeholders consist of all stratums from central and provincial


government to community level. Stakeholder mapping has been
conducted by Statoil.

Secure area of drilling point can be ascertained from modeling


result that are being made and will be incorporated into the UKLUPL document.

The procedure for drilling cuttings and drilling mud will be


carried out according to the regulated procedures. This includes
circulating drill cuttings and mud after the test set by Minister of
Energy and Mineral Decree No. 45 year 2006 concerning
Management of drilling mud, drilling mud and cuttings waste for
oil and gas drilling activity.

Safe distance of fishing vessel to drilling ship will be socialized


and notified during the drill ship operation.

Q-A SESSION II
A. QUESTION

3.1

1. HEAD OF WEST SULAWESI PROVINCE MARINE AND FISHERIES OFFICEHARUNA HAMAL

Potential problem that will physicaly occured during the drilling


activity is noise (in term of frequency) and drilling cutting disposal.

There are concenrs from the community that everytime an exploration


activity happened in the area, the fish is disappeared. If any scientific
study that can be assured that sound frequency will not affect the
fishing activity.

In early 2009, in Majene occured black oil that caused itching to the
community. The oil point of source is not known. Is there any method
to determine the origin of the oil, in order to determine who is
responsible.

2. HEAD OF WEST SULAWESI PROVINCE TRANSPORTATION OFFICE

5.1

Information regarding shipping line and infrastructure facility


available in West Sulawesi Province, such as port and airport that is
sufficient to cattered base operation requirement in West Sulawesi,
instead of in Balikpapan.

Drilling point shoul be informed to related institution for mapping


purposes.

B. RESPONSE
1. ERM-YAHYA HUSIN

Drilling cuttings and their distribution will be studied trough


modeling; the modeling result later on will be incorporated into UKLUPL.

Regarding noise and its effect on fisheries, there area scientific studies
which stated that species sensitive to sound frequency are marine
mammals such as dolphins, whales and turtles.

Helicopter will only be operated in daytime and assumed will not


give any disturbance. Drill ship operation will only generate noise in
the surface; therefore will not affect the fishing activity in Mamuju
area. Noise impact assessment will only be carried out on human.

The oil that occurred in Majene can not be appointed directly because
although there are regulation existed to prevent such problem but the
implementation of supervision in the field can not be done effectively.

Since no oil and gas exploration have been conducted in Majene (West
Sulawesi) area, the oil is most likely come from ballast water
discharge of ships crossing Makasar Straits.

Drilling coordinate will be written in UKL-UPL document.

CLOSING
CLOSING SPEECH DELIVERED BY HARUNA HAMAL (HEAD OF WEST
SULAWESI PROVINCE MARINE AND FISHERIES OFFICE)

There are many advantages of this meeting, lesson learns and


suggestions that will become part of enrichment for the future
improvement both for West Sulawesi government in particular
and Indonesia Government in general related to exploration and
exploitation in oil and gas.

We thank Statoil and all participants who have contribute to this


event.

APPENDIX 3

PRESENTATION MATERIAL PRESENTED IN PUBLIC


SOCIALIZATION

Sosialisasi Rencana Kegiatan


Eksplorasi Migas di Blok
Karama, Selat Makasar

Mamuju, 03 Desember 2009

APPENDIX 4 PHOTOS

APPENDIX 5
MASTER IMPACT TABLE

Scoping

Activity/Aspect

Impact Significance

Potential Impact

Magnitude of
Impact

Value/sensitivity
of resources/
receptor

Low

Medium

Residual Impact Significance


Mitigation
Significance

Magnitude of
Impact

Value/sensitivity
of resources/
receptor

Low

Medium

ALARP

Low

High

Moderate

Significance

Planned Activities
Air emissions from
vessels/ equipment
involved in the movement
of the drill ship to the
project site; power
generation on the drill
ship, supply vessels, and
helicopter transfers.

Reduction of air quality


from emissions (e.g.
CO2, CO, NOX, SO2,
particulates/ smoke)
and unburned
hydrocarbons in the
exhaust emissions.

Minor

Optimising operations of the


engines to optimize fuel
combustion and thus emissions;
Ensuring the use of low sulphur
fuel;
Ensuring the use of Marine Gas
Oil as fuel rather than Heavy
Fuel Oil to reduced emissions;
and
Ensuring the provision of a fuel
overflow tank system.

Noise generation during


the exploration drilling
program from propellers
and thrusters of the drill
ship and support vessels,
drilling activities and
helicopter transfers.

Marine impacts: Largely


behavioural impacts
(disruption to
movements, localised
avoidance) to marine
life, particularly marine
mammals and sea
turtles, as well as fish
species by altering the
natural underwater
noise environment.

Medium

High

ModerateMajor

Use of marine mammal observer


(MMO) to observe the presence
of marine mammals and turtles
within close proximity of the
drilling vessel prior to starting;
Record sightings of marine
mammal and turtles, details of
any problems encountered,
details of watches made for
marine mammals/ turtles and
the drilling activity during
watches;
Use of low noise thrusters and
exhaust silencers;
Use of low noise equipment; and
Optimised exploration activities.

Nearshore impacts:
Disturbance to local
communities in the area

Low

Low

Not
significant

No further mitigation needed.

Scoping

Activity/Aspect

Impact Significance

Potential Impact

Magnitude of
Impact

Value/sensitivity
of resources/
receptor

Medium

Low

Residual Impact Significance


Mitigation
Significance

Magnitude of
Impact

Value/sensitivity
of resources/
receptor

Low

Low

Not
significant

Low

Low

Not
significant

Significance

of Balikpapan from
noise generated by
helicopter transfers.
Wastes generation during
drilling and support
activities and handling,
storage, disposal of nonhazardous and hazardous
wastes.

Potential for the


following in the event
of inappropriate waste
management:

Minor

Toxic effects or
physical damage to
marine organisms;

Waste minimisation at source;


Waste segregation by type;
Transport of wastes in suitable
containers to avoid leaks, wind
blown release of waste materials;

Water pollution/
fouling/
contamination of the
sea/ shoreline or
onshore environment
(onshore storage,
transport and
disposal activities);

Completion of transportation
consignment notes to document
the transfer of materials from
offshore to onshore;
Recycling of waste where
possible; and

Risks of fire and


explosion; and

Compliance with MARPOL


Annex V requirements (including
the prohibition of disposal of
garbage into the sea) on the
drilling vessel, support and
supply vessels.

Risks to human
health.

Well drilling and


discharge of drilling
wastes and excess cement,
wastewater, ballast water
and rainwater runoff.

Contamination of the
marine environment
(reduction of water
quality, increased
suspended solids, and
seabed blanketing from
settling of drill cuttings)
leading to toxic effects/
smothering of marine

Waste Management System


(vessels Pollution Control and
Waste Management Procedure),
detailing:

Low

Medium

Minor

Careful monitoring of activities


to ensure conducted in a
controlled manner to reduce
disturbance to seabed; and
Conducting a comprehensive
baseline of the area to determine
the likely species present and
their sensitivity prior to

Scoping

Activity/Aspect

Impact Significance

Potential Impact

Magnitude of
Impact

Value/sensitivity
of resources/
receptor

Residual Impact Significance


Mitigation
Significance

fauna and sensitive


marine habitats,
including coral reef and
mangrove ecosystems,
as well as community
fish ponds.
Well drilling, supply and
support activities and
physical presence of the
rig, supply and support
vessels in the area.

Requirement for
physical exclusion
zones and prevention of
access the fishing
areas/other sea users,
interference with
existing sea users
during mobilisation and
supply/support
activities, requirement
to remove rumpon or
fish aggregation devices
from the proposed
drilling locations and
income/subsistence
impacts on local
fishermen/communities

Magnitude of
Impact

Value/sensitivity
of resources/
receptor

Low

Medium

Significance

beginning project activities.

Medium

Medium

Moderate

Notify fishing authorities of


planned activities;
Maintain communication with
local communities/ fishermen
notifying them of planned
activities and understanding
their concerns; and
Procedures in place for dealing
with claims/compensation for
damaged fishing gear etc. from
local fishermen.

Minor

Scoping

Activity/Aspect

Drilling program

Impact Significance

Potential Impact

Increased employment
opportunities/
stimulation of local
economy surrounding
the Balikpapan supply
base

Magnitude of
Impact

Low
Medium

Value/sensitivity
of resources/
receptor
-

Residual Impact Significance


Mitigation
Significance

Not
significant
Minor
positive

Prioritise engagement of
Indonesian-based service and
supply contractors

Magnitude of
Impact

Value/sensitivity
of resources/
receptor

Medium

Significance

Minor

Scoping

Activity/Aspect

Impact Significance

Potential Impact

Magnitude of
Impact

Value/sensitivity
of resources/
receptor

High

High

Residual Impact Significance


Mitigation
Significance

Magnitude of
Impact

Value/sensitivity
of resources/
receptor

Medium

Medium

Significance

Unplanned events
Well blow out and
uncontrolled release of
hydrocarbons;

Large oil spill leading to


multiple impacts:

and

Contamination of the
marine environment;

Vessel collision, loss of


vessel inventory

Toxic effects on
marine fauna;
Contamination of
coastline and oil
fouling;
Toxic effects on
coastal flora/fauna;
Impacts on fisheries,
including sea fisheries
and coastal
mariculture;
Disruption to
transportation and
shipping;
Livelihood impacts on
dependent /affected
communities;
Risks of fire and
explosion; and
Risks to human
health.

Major

Development of an Oil Spill


Contingency Plan that identifies
responsibilities of relevant
personnel, defines spill response
actions (eg. for Tier 1, Tier 2 and
Tier 3), describes actions to be
taken in the event of a spill,
communication procedures,
reporting procedures, etc,
including ensuring that spill
response mechanisms are in
place and located in a logistically
suitable location (ie. locally
based) that enables quick
response time;
Provision, implementation and
training of all staff on an
Emergency Prevention and
Response Plans, including
emergency training exercises;
Ensuring a model can be run live
in case of a spill;
Ensure of notices to other
mariners of activities in the area;
and
Presence of support vessels to
warn other vessels in the area.

Moderate

APPENDIX 6

DRILLING CHEMICAL CHARACTERISTICS

Appendix 6

Environmental Characteristics of Drilling Fluids

Constituent (Trade
Name)

Compound

Function

Appearance *

Spill Behaviour *

Ecological Info *

Bioaccumulation
Potential *

OCNS
Product
Warnings **

HQ or OCNS
Group **

Degradability *

Water Based Muds


BARAZAN D

Xanthum gum

Viscosifer

White to yellow powder

Soluble in water

No data provided

No data
provided

No data provided

Barite

Barite

Additive

Pink to tan grey solid

Insoluble in water

No data provided

No data
provided

No data provided

Bentonite

Bentonite

Weight additive

Solid

Insoluble in water

No data provided

No data
provided

No data provided

White solid

Soluble in water

No data provided

No data
provided

Does not
decompose

White solid pellets

Insoluble in water

Does not
bioaccumulate

Does not
biodegrade

Mixes with water

Concentration greater than 10 ppm or


pH greater than 10.5 may be toxic to
fish and other organisms
Prevent spillage from entering water
courses

No data
provided

No data provided

Calcium Chloride (brine) Calcium chloride

Caustic Soda

Sodium hydroxide

Soluble weighting/ bridging


agent, osmotic control,
stabilizer, accelerator, source
of calcium
pH controller

Gum Xanthan

Gum Xanthan

Stabiliser/ emulsifying agent

Cream to tan coloured


powder

PAC-LE

Cellulose derivative

Fluid loss additive

White to off-white powder Forms a gel in water

No data provided

Not determined

Readily
biodegradable

Soda Ash

Sodium carbonate

pH controller

White powder

Partially soluble in
water

Prevent spillage from entering water


courses

No data
provided

No data provided

Sodium Bicarbonate

Sodium bicarbonate

pH controller

White solid

Soluble in water

No date provided

Not determined

Slowly
biodegradable

Calcium Carbonate, fine Calcium carbonate,


crystalline silica quarts

Additive

Light tan solid

Soluble in water

No data provided

No data
provided

No data provided

Calcium Chloride
(powder)

Calcium chloride

White solid

Soluble in water

No data provided

No data
provided

No data provided

EDC 95/11

Benzene

Soluble weighting/ bridging


agent, osmotic control,
stabilizer, accelerator, source
of calcium
Base oil

Colourless liquid

Insoluble in water

No data
provided

76% in 28 days
Biodegradable in
seawater

EZ MUL NT

Emulsifier/ wetting agent

Dark amber liquid

Insoluble in water

No data
provided

No data provided

Lime hydrated

Hydrotreated light
distillate, ethylene glycol
monobutyl
Ether, diethylene glycol
monobutyl
ether
Calcium hydroxide

LC 50, 96 Hrs, Fish mg/l: >100


This product must be essentially
harmless for aquatic and land-based
life and
would be intrinsically biodegradable.
Avoid water and soil pollution
EC50: 1701 mg/l (Corophium
volutator),
Prevent from entering waterways

Alkalinity agent

White solid

Insoluble in water.
Sinks in water.

TLM96: 100-500 ppm (Oncorhynchus No data


mykiss)
provided

No data provided

LIQUITONE

Latex

HTHP filtration agent

Milky white liquid

Disperses in water

Prevent from entering waterways

No data
provided

No data provided

Gold

RHEMOD L

Fatty acids, propriety


components

Rheology/ suspension

Dark liquid

Insoluble in water

Prevent from entering waterways

No data
provided

No data provided

Synthetic Based Muds

Constituent (Trade
Name)

Compound

Function

Appearance *

Spill Behaviour *

Ecological Info *

Bioaccumulation
Potential *

OCNS
Product
Warnings **

HQ or OCNS
Group **

Degradability *

Contingency Chemicals
Calcium carbonate

Calcium carbonate,
crystalline silica quarts

Additive

Light tan solid

Soluble in water

No data provided

No data
provided

No data provided

Aldacide G

Glutaraldehyde

Biocide

Transparent liquid

Soluble in water

Prevent from entering waterways.


May be highly toxic to aquatic life.

No data
provided

Readily
biodegradable

Silver, C

Graphite Fine

No data provided

No data provided

No data provided

No data provided

No data provided

No data
provided

No data provided

Graphite Medium

No data provided

No data provided

No data provided

No data provided

No data provided

No data
provided

No data provided

Kwil-Seal

Blend of vegetable and


polymer fibres

Additive

Blend of various coloured Insoluble in water


particles

Not toxic to aquatic organisms

No data
provided

No data provided

Barofibre F/MC

Natural Plant Fiber

Additive

Red brown powder

Insoluble in water

No data provided

No data
provided

Biodegradable

Nut Plug F/M/C

Coconut shell

Fluid loss reducer

Brown, granular

Insoluble in water

No data provided

No data
provided

No data provided

Silver

Super Sweep

Viscosifer

BARAKLEAN

2-Ethyl hexanol

Corrosion inhibitor

Light straw liquid

Emulsifies

Prevent from entering waterways.


EC50: > 1890 mg/l (Corophium
volutator)
TLM96: 36.75-696.3 mg/l (Cyprinus
carpio)

No data
provided

Slowly
biodegradable

Gold, D

Substitution
warning

GELTONE II

Modified bentonite

Viscosifier

Tan powder

Insoluble in water

No data
provided

No data provided

COLDTROL

Alcohol adducts

Surfactant

Colourless liquid

Soluble in water

Prevent from entering waterways.


TLM96: 1-10 mg/l (Golden orfe)

No data
provided

Readily
biodegradable

DRILL TREAT

Lipid

Oil-wetting Agent

Amber liquid

Disperses in water

No data provided

No data
provided

Biodegradable

TEG

No data provided

No data provided

No data provided

No data provided

No data provided

No data
provided

No data provided

N-SQUEEZE

Blend of natural fibres

Loss Circulation Material

Light brown solid

Forms a gel

No data provided

No data
provided

Readily
biodegradable

N-PLEX

Sodium hydroxide,
sodium borate

Loss Circulation Material

Clear colourless liquid

Soluble in water

Prevent from entering waterways

No data
provided

No data provided

Liquid Acelelator D077

Calcium chloride

Acelelator

Clear yellow-brown
liquid

Soluble in water

Low toxicity to fish

No data
provided

No data provided

Antifoam Agent D 47

Polypropylene glycol

Antifoam

Clear liquid

Soluble in water

No data provided

No data
provided

Not biodegradable E

Liquid Antisetlling
D162

Hydrotreated light
Petroleum distillates

Antsettling

Off-white liquid

Disperses in water

No data provided B- D

Barite D 31

Barium sulphate

Barite

White powder

Low solubility in water

LC50(10d) = 290 mg/kg (Corophium No data


volutator); EC50(72h) = >1000 mg/l provided
(Skeletonema costatum);
LC50(48h) = 6.7 mg/l (Acartia
Tonsa)
May be highly toxic to some
aquatic organisms
No data provided
No data
provided

No data provided

Cement

Constituent (Trade
Name)

Compound

Function

Appearance *

Spill Behaviour *

Ecological Info *

SALBOND II Additive D Aromatic polymer


80A
derivative

Dispersant

Dark brown liquid

Soluble in water

Do not allow material to


contaminate ground water system.

Low temperature
Liquid Dispersant D
145A
Low temperature
Dispersant D 185

Amine polymer
derivative

Dispersant

Clear to hazy yellow


liquid

Soluble in water

Aliphatic acid copolymer

Dispersant

Colourless liquid

Soluble in water

Low temperature
Extender D 154

Non-crystalline silica

Extander

Grey-white powder

Insoluble in water

Prevent further leakage or spillage.


Keep out of
waterways.
Fish toxicity: 96h LC50= >500 mg/l
(Scophthalamus maximus
juvenile)
This product has no known ecotoxicological effects

Silicate Additive D 75

Silicic acid, sodium salt

Extander

Colourless liquid

Soluble in water

Litefil D 124 Extender

Aluminum silicate

Extander

Tan-grey powder

Insoluble in water

Uniflac L D 168

Aliphatic amide polymer

Fluid Loss Control

Clear/ colourless yellow Soluble in water


liquid

Fluid Control Additive


D193

Organic polymer,
Fluid Loss Control, gas Control Colourless liquid
Hexahydro-1,3,5-tris(2hydroxyethyl)-sym-triazine

Soluble in water

Cement Class G D 907

Portland cement

Bioaccumulation
Degradability *
Potential *
Not likely to
Not readily
bioaccumulate
biodegradable

OCNS
Product
Warnings **

HQ or OCNS
Group **
-

log Pow = < -5

17 % in 28 days

Does not
bioaccumulate

Not readily
biodegradable

Gold

Substitution
warning

No data
provided

No data provided

PLONOR

None required

No data
provided

No data provided

PLONOR, E

None required

No data
provided

No data provided

PLONOR

Prevent further leakage or spillage


72h EC50= 45 mg/l (Skeletonema
costatum)
Prevent further leakage or spillage;
80% (28 days)
72h EC50= 3 - 300 mg/l
(Skeletonema costatum)
No data provided

Does not
bioaccumulate

Partially
biodegradable

Gold, E

Low
Biodegradable
bioaccumulation

Gold

No data
provided

Does not
Biodegradable
bioaccumulate

C, Gold

Substitution
warning

Cement

Grey powder

Misicible in water

Organic polymer, Amine


polymer, Hexahydro1,3,5-tris(2hydroxyethyl)-symtriazine
Low temperature
Inorganic nitrogen
Cement Set Enhancer D compound, Aliphatic
186
alcohol, 2,2'methyliminodiethanol,
Inorganic bromine
compound
Micro Cement D169
Portland cement

Gas Block

Green liquid

Soluble in water

Low temperature Cement


Enhancer

Light green liquid

Soluble in water

No data provided

Does not
bioaccumulate

No data provided

Some
components
listed as
PLONOR

Microfine Cement

Grey powder

Misicible in water

No data provided

No data
provided

No data provided

Liquid retarder D81

Calcium lignosulfonate

Retarder

Dark brown liquid

Soluble in water

No data provided

No data
provided

Not readily
biodegradable

PLONOR, E

Uniset-LT D177

Phosphoric acid,
Pentasodium EDTMP

Retarder

Light green liquid

Soluble in water

72h EC50=9 mg/l (Skeletonema


costatum)

Does not
bioaccumulate

Not biodegradable -

Sulfactant F057

SALT OF SULFONATED Sulfactant


AROMATIC ACID,
ALIPHATIC ALCOHOL
GLYCOL
ETHER, SALT OF
AROMATIC ACID
Bentonite, Glucoside
Vicosifier
polymer

Yellow liquid

Soluble in water

Harmful to aquatic organisms

No data
provided

Partially
biodegradable.

Off-white solid

Partially soluble

No data provided

Not likely to
bioaccumulate

Readily
biodegradable

PLONOR

Gas Block LT D500

Spacer B250

No data provided

Notes:
NA means information not available
HQ means Hazard Quotient under OSPARs Offshore Chemical Notification System (OCNS). Gold = lowest ecological hazard; while purple = highest. (See below for description)
OCNS Group reflects an alternate hazard assessment system adopted under OCNS; with A being the greatest potential environmental hazard and E being the least. Products that only contain substances termed PLONORs (Pose Little or No Risk)

Constituent (Trade
Name)

Compound

Function

Appearance *

Spill Behaviour *

Ecological Info *

Bioaccumulation
Potential *

are given the OCNS E grouping. (See below for description)


Product Warnings: are defined under the OCNS and indicate a product containing any percentage of hazardous chemicals listed in OSPARCOMs Annex A. Zn = Zinc, Cr = Chromium

Sources:
* Individual Material Safety Data Sheets for each product
** CEFAS, BERR, Staatstoezicht op de Mijnen, 2002; Offshore Chemical Notification Scheme List of Notified and Ranked Products.

Degradability *

HQ or OCNS
Group **

OCNS
Product
Warnings **

Explanation of OCNS Categories and Risk Assessment


Under OSPARs Offshore Chemical Notification System (OCNS), chemicals
used in the offshore oil and gas industry are assessed in terms of their
ecological hazard. Two approaches are used depending on the use of the
chemical; either a Hazard Quotient (HQ) is given; expressed as a Colour
Band; or an OCNS Group, expressed as a letter from A to E.
OCNS Hazard Quotient (HQ)
The HQ is the ratio between the Predicted Effect Concentration and the No
Effect Concentration (PEC:NEC) and is expressed as a colour banding. Data
used to define the Effects include toxicity, biodegradation and
bioaccumulation. The HQ colour codes are interpreted as follows:
The OCNS HQ and colour bands

Minimum HQ value

Maximum HQ value

Colour banding

>0

<1

Gold

<30

Silver

30

<100

White

Lowest Hazard

100

<300

Blue

Highest Hazard

300

<1000

Orange

1000

Purple

OCNS Group
Some products are categorized into an OCNS Group of A-E instead (ie.
inorganic substances, hydraulic fluids or chemicals used only in pipelines),
with A being the greatest potential environmental hazard and E being the
least (see below table). Factors considered in defining the environmental risk
are also toxicity, biodegradation and bioaccumulation. Letter groups are
provided as follows:

The OCNS letter grouping


Initial OCNS
grouping
A
B
C
D
E

Result for aquatic


toxicity (mg/l)
<1
>1 - 10
>10 - 100
>100 - 1,000
>1,000

Result for sediment


toxicity (mg/l)
<10
>10 - 100
>100 - 1,000
>1,000 - 10,000
>10,000

Hazard Risk
Highest

Lowest

Products that only contain substances termed PLONORs (Pose Little or


No Risk) are given the OCNS E grouping.

This information is derived from : http://www.cefas.co.uk/offshorechemical-notification-scheme-(ocns)/hazard-assessment.aspx.


Further information on the OCNS Classification System and
Hazard Assessment methods is available at this website.

You might also like